PR ipa/65648
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blobdc13a14f4e7860a08612d855e2b84804dda5ab7e
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
7 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
8 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
9 version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
12 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
13 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
14 for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "tm.h"
24 #include "machmode.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "hash-set.h"
27 #include "vec.h"
28 #include "double-int.h"
29 #include "input.h"
30 #include "alias.h"
31 #include "symtab.h"
32 #include "wide-int.h"
33 #include "inchash.h"
34 #include "tree.h"
35 #include "fold-const.h"
36 #include "stringpool.h"
37 #include "stor-layout.h"
38 #include "attribs.h"
39 #include "varasm.h"
40 #include "flags.h"
41 #include "regs.h"
42 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
43 #include "except.h"
44 #include "function.h"
45 #include "insn-config.h"
46 #include "insn-attr.h"
47 #include "hashtab.h"
48 #include "statistics.h"
49 #include "real.h"
50 #include "fixed-value.h"
51 #include "expmed.h"
52 #include "dojump.h"
53 #include "explow.h"
54 #include "calls.h"
55 #include "emit-rtl.h"
56 #include "stmt.h"
57 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
58 #include "expr.h"
59 #include "insn-codes.h"
60 #include "optabs.h"
61 #include "libfuncs.h"
62 #include "recog.h"
63 #include "reload.h"
64 #include "typeclass.h"
65 #include "toplev.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "intl.h"
68 #include "tm_p.h"
69 #include "tree-iterator.h"
70 #include "predict.h"
71 #include "dominance.h"
72 #include "cfg.h"
73 #include "basic-block.h"
74 #include "tree-ssa-alias.h"
75 #include "internal-fn.h"
76 #include "gimple-expr.h"
77 #include "is-a.h"
78 #include "gimple.h"
79 #include "gimple-ssa.h"
80 #include "hash-map.h"
81 #include "plugin-api.h"
82 #include "ipa-ref.h"
83 #include "cgraph.h"
84 #include "tree-ssanames.h"
85 #include "target.h"
86 #include "common/common-target.h"
87 #include "timevar.h"
88 #include "df.h"
89 #include "diagnostic.h"
90 #include "tree-ssa-live.h"
91 #include "tree-outof-ssa.h"
92 #include "target-globals.h"
93 #include "params.h"
94 #include "tree-ssa-address.h"
95 #include "cfgexpand.h"
96 #include "builtins.h"
97 #include "tree-chkp.h"
98 #include "rtl-chkp.h"
99 #include "ccmp.h"
101 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
102 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
103 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
104 #else
105 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
106 #endif
107 #endif
110 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
111 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
112 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
113 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
114 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
115 the same indirect address eventually. */
116 int cse_not_expected;
118 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
119 be performed. */
120 struct move_by_pieces_d
122 rtx to;
123 rtx to_addr;
124 int autinc_to;
125 int explicit_inc_to;
126 rtx from;
127 rtx from_addr;
128 int autinc_from;
129 int explicit_inc_from;
130 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
131 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
132 int reverse;
135 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
136 be performed. */
138 struct store_by_pieces_d
140 rtx to;
141 rtx to_addr;
142 int autinc_to;
143 int explicit_inc_to;
144 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
145 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
146 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, machine_mode);
147 void *constfundata;
148 int reverse;
151 static void move_by_pieces_1 (insn_gen_fn, machine_mode,
152 struct move_by_pieces_d *);
153 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
154 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT,
155 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
156 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
157 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
158 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
159 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, machine_mode);
160 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
161 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *, unsigned int);
162 static void store_by_pieces_2 (insn_gen_fn, machine_mode,
163 struct store_by_pieces_d *);
164 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
165 static rtx_insn *compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
166 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
167 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
168 HOST_WIDE_INT, machine_mode,
169 tree, int, alias_set_type);
170 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
171 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT,
172 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
173 machine_mode, tree, alias_set_type, bool);
175 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
177 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
178 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
179 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, machine_mode);
180 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
181 static void emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode, rtx, tree);
182 #endif
183 static void do_tablejump (rtx, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
184 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
185 static tree tree_expr_size (const_tree);
186 static HOST_WIDE_INT int_expr_size (tree);
189 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
190 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
191 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
193 void
194 init_expr_target (void)
196 rtx insn, pat;
197 machine_mode mode;
198 int num_clobbers;
199 rtx mem, mem1;
200 rtx reg;
202 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
203 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
204 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
205 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
206 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
208 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
209 useless RTL allocations. */
210 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
212 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
213 pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
214 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
216 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
217 mode = (machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
219 int regno;
221 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
222 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
223 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
224 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
226 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
227 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
229 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
230 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
231 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
232 regno++)
234 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
235 continue;
237 SET_REGNO (reg, regno);
239 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
240 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
241 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
242 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
244 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
245 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
246 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
247 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
249 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
250 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
251 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
252 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
254 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
255 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
256 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
257 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
261 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
263 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
264 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
266 machine_mode srcmode;
267 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
268 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
270 enum insn_code ic;
272 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
273 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
274 continue;
276 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
278 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
279 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
284 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
286 void
287 init_expr (void)
289 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
292 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
293 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
294 fixed-point.
295 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
296 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
298 void
299 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
301 machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
302 machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
303 int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
304 int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
305 enum insn_code code;
306 rtx libcall;
308 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
309 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
310 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
313 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
314 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
315 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
317 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
318 nothing to do. */
319 if (to == from)
320 return;
322 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
323 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
324 TO here. */
326 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
327 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
328 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
329 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (from, unsignedp))
330 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
332 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
334 if (to_mode == from_mode
335 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
337 emit_move_insn (to, from);
338 return;
341 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
343 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
345 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
346 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
347 else
348 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
350 emit_move_insn (to, from);
351 return;
354 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
356 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
357 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
358 return;
361 if (to_real)
363 rtx value;
364 rtx_insn *insns;
365 convert_optab tab;
367 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
368 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
369 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
370 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
372 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
373 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
374 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
375 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
376 tab = sext_optab;
377 else
378 tab = trunc_optab;
380 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
382 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
383 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
385 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
386 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
387 return;
390 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
391 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
393 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
394 gcc_assert (libcall);
396 start_sequence ();
397 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
398 1, from, from_mode);
399 insns = get_insns ();
400 end_sequence ();
401 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
402 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
403 from)
404 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
405 return;
408 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
409 /* If the target has a converter from FROM_MODE to TO_MODE, use it. */
411 convert_optab ctab;
413 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
414 ctab = trunc_optab;
415 else if (unsignedp)
416 ctab = zext_optab;
417 else
418 ctab = sext_optab;
420 if (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode)
421 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
423 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode),
424 to, from, UNKNOWN);
425 return;
429 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
430 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
431 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
433 machine_mode full_mode
434 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
436 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
437 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
439 if (full_mode != from_mode)
440 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
441 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
442 to, from, UNKNOWN);
443 return;
445 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
447 rtx new_from;
448 machine_mode full_mode
449 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
450 convert_optab ctab = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
451 enum insn_code icode;
453 icode = convert_optab_handler (ctab, full_mode, from_mode);
454 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
456 if (to_mode == full_mode)
458 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, UNKNOWN);
459 return;
462 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
463 emit_unop_insn (icode, new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
465 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
466 from_mode = full_mode;
467 from = new_from;
470 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
471 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
472 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
473 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
475 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
476 we won't saturate the result.
477 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
478 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
479 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
480 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
481 else
482 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
483 return;
486 /* Now both modes are integers. */
488 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
489 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
490 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
492 rtx_insn *insns;
493 rtx lowpart;
494 rtx fill_value;
495 rtx lowfrom;
496 int i;
497 machine_mode lowpart_mode;
498 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
500 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
501 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
502 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
504 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
505 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
506 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
507 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
508 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
509 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
510 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
511 return;
513 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
514 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
515 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
516 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
518 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
519 if (REG_P (to))
521 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
522 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
523 emit_clobber (to);
525 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
526 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
527 return;
530 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
531 start_sequence ();
533 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure the
534 the source does not overlap the target so force it into an isolated
535 register when maybe so. Likewise for any MEM input, since the
536 conversion sequence might require several references to it and we
537 must ensure we're getting the same value every time. */
539 if (MEM_P (from) || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
540 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
542 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
543 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
544 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
545 else
546 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
548 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
550 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
551 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
553 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
554 if (unsignedp)
555 fill_value = const0_rtx;
556 else
557 fill_value = emit_store_flag_force (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
558 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
559 lowpart_mode, 0, -1);
561 /* Fill the remaining words. */
562 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
564 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
565 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
567 gcc_assert (subword);
569 if (fill_value != subword)
570 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
573 insns = get_insns ();
574 end_sequence ();
576 emit_insn (insns);
577 return;
580 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
581 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
582 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
584 if (!((MEM_P (from)
585 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
586 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
587 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
588 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
589 || REG_P (from)
590 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
591 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
592 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
593 return;
596 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
597 no more than a word long. */
599 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
600 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
601 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
603 if (!((MEM_P (from)
604 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
605 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
606 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
607 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
608 || REG_P (from)
609 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
610 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
611 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
612 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
613 from = copy_to_reg (from);
614 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
615 return;
618 /* Handle extension. */
619 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
621 /* Convert directly if that works. */
622 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
623 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
625 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
626 return;
628 else
630 machine_mode intermediate;
631 rtx tmp;
632 int shift_amount;
634 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
635 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
636 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
637 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
638 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
639 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
640 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, intermediate)))
641 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
642 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
644 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
645 unsignedp), unsignedp);
646 return;
649 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
650 Generate what we need with shifts. */
651 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
652 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
653 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
654 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
655 to, unsignedp);
656 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
657 to, unsignedp);
658 if (tmp != to)
659 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
660 return;
664 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
665 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
666 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
668 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
669 to, from, UNKNOWN);
670 return;
673 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
674 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
675 and for which there was no special instruction.
677 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
678 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
679 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
680 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
682 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
683 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
684 return;
687 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
688 gcc_unreachable ();
691 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
692 from converting X to mode MODE.
693 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
694 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
695 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
696 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
699 convert_to_mode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
701 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
704 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
705 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
706 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
707 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
709 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
710 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
712 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
715 convert_modes (machine_mode mode, machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
717 rtx temp;
719 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
720 the required extension, strip it. */
722 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
723 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
724 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (x, unsignedp))
725 x = gen_lowpart (mode, SUBREG_REG (x));
727 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
728 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
730 if (mode == oldmode)
731 return x;
733 if (CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (x) && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
735 /* If the caller did not tell us the old mode, then there is not
736 much to do with respect to canonicalization. We have to
737 assume that all the bits are significant. */
738 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) != MODE_INT)
739 oldmode = MAX_MODE_INT;
740 wide_int w = wide_int::from (std::make_pair (x, oldmode),
741 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode),
742 unsignedp ? UNSIGNED : SIGNED);
743 return immed_wide_int_const (w, mode);
746 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
747 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
748 non-volatile MEM. */
749 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
750 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
751 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode)
752 && ((MEM_P (x) && !MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) && direct_load[(int) mode])
753 || (REG_P (x)
754 && (!HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
755 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
756 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (mode, GET_MODE (x)))))
758 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
760 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
761 subreg operation. */
762 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
764 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
765 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
768 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
769 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
770 return temp;
773 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
774 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
776 static unsigned int
777 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
779 machine_mode tmode;
781 tmode = mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
782 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
783 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
784 else
786 machine_mode tmode, xmode;
788 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
789 tmode != VOIDmode;
790 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
791 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
792 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
793 break;
795 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
798 return align;
801 /* Return the widest integer mode no wider than SIZE. If no such mode
802 can be found, return VOIDmode. */
804 static machine_mode
805 widest_int_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
807 machine_mode tmode, mode = VOIDmode;
809 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
810 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
811 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < size)
812 mode = tmode;
814 return mode;
817 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
818 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
819 succeed. */
822 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
823 unsigned int align)
825 return targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align, MOVE_BY_PIECES,
826 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ());
829 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
830 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
832 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
833 used to push FROM to the stack.
835 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
837 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
838 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
839 stpcpy. */
842 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
843 unsigned int align, int endp)
845 struct move_by_pieces_d data;
846 machine_mode to_addr_mode;
847 machine_mode from_addr_mode = get_address_mode (from);
848 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
849 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
850 enum insn_code icode;
852 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
854 data.offset = 0;
855 data.from_addr = from_addr;
856 if (to)
858 to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
859 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
860 data.to = to;
861 data.autinc_to
862 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
863 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
864 data.reverse
865 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
867 else
869 to_addr_mode = VOIDmode;
870 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
871 data.to = NULL_RTX;
872 data.autinc_to = 1;
873 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
874 data.reverse = 1;
875 #else
876 data.reverse = 0;
877 #endif
879 data.to_addr = to_addr;
880 data.from = from;
881 data.autinc_from
882 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
883 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
884 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
886 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
887 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
888 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
889 data.len = len;
891 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
892 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
893 and use post-increment if available. */
894 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
895 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
897 /* Find the mode of the largest move...
898 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
899 USE_* macros below. */
900 machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
901 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
903 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
905 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode,
906 plus_constant (from_addr_mode,
907 from_addr, len));
908 data.autinc_from = 1;
909 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
911 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
913 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
914 data.autinc_from = 1;
915 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
917 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
918 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
919 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
921 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
922 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
923 to_addr, len));
924 data.autinc_to = 1;
925 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
927 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
929 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
930 data.autinc_to = 1;
931 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
933 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
934 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
937 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
939 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
940 successively smaller modes. */
942 while (max_size > 1 && data.len > 0)
944 machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
946 if (mode == VOIDmode)
947 break;
949 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
950 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
951 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
953 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
956 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
957 gcc_assert (!data.len);
959 if (endp)
961 rtx to1;
963 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
964 if (data.autinc_to)
966 if (endp == 2)
968 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
969 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
970 else
971 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
972 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
973 data.to_addr,
974 -1));
976 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
977 data.offset);
979 else
981 if (endp == 2)
982 --data.offset;
983 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
985 return to1;
987 else
988 return data.to;
991 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
992 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
994 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
995 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
996 unsigned int max_size)
998 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1000 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1002 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
1004 machine_mode mode;
1005 enum insn_code icode;
1007 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
1009 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1010 break;
1012 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1013 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1014 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1016 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1019 gcc_assert (!l);
1020 return n_insns;
1023 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1024 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1025 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1027 static void
1028 move_by_pieces_1 (insn_gen_fn genfun, machine_mode mode,
1029 struct move_by_pieces_d *data)
1031 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1032 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1034 while (data->len >= size)
1036 if (data->reverse)
1037 data->offset -= size;
1039 if (data->to)
1041 if (data->autinc_to)
1042 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1043 data->offset);
1044 else
1045 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1048 if (data->autinc_from)
1049 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1050 data->offset);
1051 else
1052 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1054 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1055 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1056 gen_int_mode (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size,
1057 GET_MODE (data->to_addr))));
1058 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1059 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1060 gen_int_mode (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size,
1061 GET_MODE (data->from_addr))));
1063 if (data->to)
1064 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1065 else
1067 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1068 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1069 #else
1070 gcc_unreachable ();
1071 #endif
1074 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1075 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1076 gen_int_mode (size,
1077 GET_MODE (data->to_addr))));
1078 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1079 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1080 gen_int_mode (size,
1081 GET_MODE (data->from_addr))));
1083 if (! data->reverse)
1084 data->offset += size;
1086 data->len -= size;
1090 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1091 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1092 or with a library call.
1094 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1095 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1096 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1097 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1098 MIN_SIZE is the minimal size of block to move
1099 MAX_SIZE is the maximal size of block to move, if it can not be represented
1100 in unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, than it is mask of all ones.
1102 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1103 0 otherwise. */
1106 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1107 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
1108 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
1109 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
1110 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
1112 bool may_use_call;
1113 rtx retval = 0;
1114 unsigned int align;
1116 gcc_assert (size);
1117 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
1118 && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1119 return 0;
1121 switch (method)
1123 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1124 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1125 may_use_call = true;
1126 break;
1128 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1129 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1131 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1132 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1133 NO_DEFER_POP;
1134 break;
1136 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1137 may_use_call = false;
1138 break;
1140 default:
1141 gcc_unreachable ();
1144 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1145 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1146 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1148 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1149 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1150 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1151 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1153 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1154 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1155 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
1157 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1158 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1159 set_mem_size (x, INTVAL (size));
1160 set_mem_size (y, INTVAL (size));
1163 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && can_move_by_pieces (INTVAL (size), align))
1164 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1165 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align,
1166 expected_align, expected_size,
1167 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size))
1169 else if (may_use_call
1170 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1171 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1173 /* Since x and y are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
1174 tree EXPR as addressable. */
1175 tree y_expr = MEM_EXPR (y);
1176 tree x_expr = MEM_EXPR (x);
1177 if (y_expr)
1178 mark_addressable (y_expr);
1179 if (x_expr)
1180 mark_addressable (x_expr);
1181 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1182 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1185 else
1186 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1188 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1189 OK_DEFER_POP;
1191 return retval;
1195 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1197 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
1198 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
1199 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
1200 else
1201 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
1202 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1,
1203 min, max, max);
1206 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1207 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1208 already been placed on the stack. */
1210 static bool
1211 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1213 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1214 tree fn;
1215 #endif
1217 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1218 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1219 return true;
1221 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1222 an outgoing argument. */
1223 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1224 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1225 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1226 depend on its argument. */
1227 (void) fn;
1228 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1229 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1230 return false;
1231 #endif
1233 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1234 argument. */
1236 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
1237 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
1238 tree fn, arg;
1240 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1241 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1242 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
1244 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1245 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1247 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1248 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
1249 NULL_TREE, true);
1250 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1251 return false;
1252 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
1253 return false;
1254 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
1255 NULL_TREE, true);
1258 return true;
1261 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1262 return true if successful. */
1264 static bool
1265 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1266 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
1267 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
1268 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
1269 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
1271 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1272 machine_mode mode;
1274 if (expected_align < align)
1275 expected_align = align;
1276 if (expected_size != -1)
1278 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > probable_max_size)
1279 expected_size = probable_max_size;
1280 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
1281 expected_size = min_size;
1284 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1285 volatile_ok = 1;
1287 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1288 including more than one in the machine description unless
1289 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1291 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1292 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1294 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1296 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1297 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1298 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1299 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1300 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
1301 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
1302 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1303 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1304 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1305 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
1306 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
1308 struct expand_operand ops[9];
1309 unsigned int nops;
1311 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1312 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1313 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1314 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1315 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
1316 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
1318 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
1319 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
1320 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
1321 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
1322 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1323 if (nops >= 6)
1325 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1326 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
1328 if (nops >= 8)
1330 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
1331 /* If we can not represent the maximal size,
1332 make parameter NULL. */
1333 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
1334 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
1335 else
1336 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
1338 if (nops == 9)
1340 /* If we can not represent the maximal size,
1341 make parameter NULL. */
1342 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
1343 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
1344 else
1345 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
1347 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
1349 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1350 return true;
1355 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1356 return false;
1359 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1360 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1363 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
1365 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1366 tree call_expr, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1367 machine_mode size_mode;
1368 rtx retval;
1370 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1371 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1372 use them later. */
1374 dst_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (dst, 0));
1375 src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0));
1377 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1378 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1380 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1381 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1383 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1385 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1386 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1388 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1389 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1390 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1391 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1392 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1394 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1396 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1397 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1398 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1400 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
1402 return retval;
1405 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1406 for the function we use for block copies. */
1408 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1410 void
1411 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1413 if (!block_move_fn)
1415 tree args, fn, attrs, attr_args;
1417 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1418 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1419 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1420 NULL_TREE);
1422 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1423 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1424 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1425 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1426 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1427 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
1428 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
1430 attr_args = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE, build_string (1, "1"));
1431 attrs = tree_cons (get_identifier ("fn spec"), attr_args, NULL);
1433 decl_attributes (&fn, attrs, ATTR_FLAG_BUILT_IN);
1435 block_move_fn = fn;
1438 if (asmspec)
1439 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1442 static tree
1443 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1445 static bool emitted_extern;
1447 if (!block_move_fn)
1448 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1450 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1452 emitted_extern = true;
1453 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1456 return block_move_fn;
1459 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1460 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1461 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1463 static void
1464 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1465 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1467 rtx_code_label *cmp_label, *top_label;
1468 rtx iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1469 machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
1470 machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
1471 machine_mode iter_mode;
1473 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1474 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1475 iter_mode = word_mode;
1477 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1478 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1479 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1481 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1483 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1484 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1485 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1487 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1488 emit_label (top_label);
1490 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1491 x_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1493 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1494 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1495 y_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1497 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1498 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1500 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1502 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1503 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1504 if (tmp != iter)
1505 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1507 emit_label (cmp_label);
1509 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1510 true, top_label, REG_BR_PROB_BASE * 90 / 100);
1513 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1514 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1516 void
1517 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, machine_mode mode)
1519 int i;
1520 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1521 rtx pat;
1522 rtx_insn *last;
1523 #endif
1525 if (nregs == 0)
1526 return;
1528 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
1529 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1531 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1532 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1533 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1535 last = get_last_insn ();
1536 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1537 GEN_INT (nregs));
1538 if (pat)
1540 emit_insn (pat);
1541 return;
1543 else
1544 delete_insns_since (last);
1546 #endif
1548 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1549 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1550 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1553 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1554 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1556 void
1557 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1559 int i;
1561 if (nregs == 0)
1562 return;
1564 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1565 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1566 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1568 rtx_insn *last = get_last_insn ();
1569 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1570 GEN_INT (nregs));
1571 if (pat)
1573 emit_insn (pat);
1574 return;
1576 else
1577 delete_insns_since (last);
1579 #endif
1581 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1583 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1585 gcc_assert (tem);
1587 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1591 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1592 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1593 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1594 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1595 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1598 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1600 int i, length;
1601 rtx *tmps;
1603 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1605 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1606 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
1608 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1609 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1611 if (i)
1612 tmps[0] = 0;
1614 for (; i < length; i++)
1616 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1617 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1619 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1622 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1625 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
1626 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
1627 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
1629 static void
1630 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
1632 rtx src;
1633 int start, i;
1634 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
1636 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1638 if (m != VOIDmode
1639 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1640 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
1641 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
1643 machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1644 if (imode == BLKmode)
1645 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize);
1646 else
1647 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1648 if (imode != BLKmode)
1649 src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
1650 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1651 /* ...and back again. */
1652 if (imode != BLKmode)
1653 src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
1654 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1655 return;
1658 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1659 both on the stack and in registers. */
1660 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1661 start = 0;
1662 else
1663 start = 1;
1665 /* Process the pieces. */
1666 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1668 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1669 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1670 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1671 int shift = 0;
1673 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1674 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1676 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1677 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1678 if (
1679 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1680 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1681 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1682 #else
1683 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1684 #endif
1686 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1687 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1688 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1691 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1692 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1693 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1694 src = orig_src;
1695 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1696 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1697 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1698 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1700 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1701 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1702 else
1703 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1705 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1708 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1709 if (MEM_P (src)
1710 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1711 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1712 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1713 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1715 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1716 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1718 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
1719 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
1720 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1721 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
1722 tmps[i] = src;
1723 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1725 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1726 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1728 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1729 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1731 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1732 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1733 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1734 to be extracted. */
1735 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1736 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1737 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1738 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1739 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1740 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1742 else
1744 rtx mem;
1746 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1747 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1748 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1749 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1750 0, 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1753 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1754 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1755 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1756 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1757 && REG_P (src))
1759 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1760 rtx mem;
1762 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1763 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1764 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1766 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1767 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1768 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE (dst), bytepos);
1769 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
1771 HOST_WIDE_INT len = (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen;
1773 if (len == ssize)
1774 tmps[i] = src;
1775 else
1777 rtx first, second;
1779 /* TODO: const_wide_int can have sizes other than this... */
1780 gcc_assert (2 * len == ssize);
1781 split_double (src, &first, &second);
1782 if (i)
1783 tmps[i] = second;
1784 else
1785 tmps[i] = first;
1788 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
1789 tmps[i] = src;
1790 else
1791 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1792 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
1793 mode, mode);
1795 if (shift)
1796 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1797 shift, tmps[i], 0);
1801 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1802 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1803 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1804 if not known. */
1806 void
1807 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1809 rtx *tmps;
1810 int i;
1812 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1813 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1815 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1816 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1818 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
1819 if (d == NULL)
1820 continue;
1821 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
1825 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
1826 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
1827 in the right place. */
1830 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1832 rtvec vec;
1833 int i;
1835 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
1836 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
1838 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
1839 with the computed values. */
1840 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
1842 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
1843 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1845 if (d)
1847 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
1848 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
1850 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1853 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
1856 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1857 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1859 void
1860 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1862 int i;
1864 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1865 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1866 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1868 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1869 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1870 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1871 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1874 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
1877 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
1879 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
1880 int i;
1882 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1884 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
1885 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1887 if (d)
1888 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
1889 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1892 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
1895 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1896 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1897 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1898 known. */
1900 void
1901 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1903 rtx *tmps, dst;
1904 int start, finish, i;
1905 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
1907 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1909 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1910 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
1912 machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1913 if (imode == BLKmode)
1914 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize);
1915 else
1916 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1917 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
1918 if (imode != BLKmode)
1919 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
1920 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1921 return;
1924 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1925 both on the stack and in registers. */
1926 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1927 start = 0;
1928 else
1929 start = 1;
1930 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
1932 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
1934 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1935 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1937 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1938 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1940 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1941 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1943 else
1944 tmps[i] = reg;
1947 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1948 from strange tricks we might play. */
1949 dst = orig_dst;
1950 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1952 rtx temp;
1954 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1955 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1956 so no action is necessary. */
1957 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1958 return;
1960 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1961 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1962 the temporary. */
1963 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize);
1964 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1965 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1966 return;
1968 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1970 machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
1971 machine_mode inner;
1972 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
1973 bool done = false;
1974 rtx temp;
1976 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1977 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
1979 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1980 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
1981 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
1982 initialize the destination. */
1983 if (start < finish)
1985 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
1986 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1987 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
1989 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
1990 inner, 0);
1991 if (temp)
1993 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1994 done = true;
1995 start++;
2000 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
2001 if (!done
2002 && start < finish - 1)
2004 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
2005 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
2006 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
2008 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
2009 inner, 0);
2010 if (temp)
2012 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
2013 done = true;
2014 finish--;
2019 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
2020 if (!done)
2021 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
2024 /* Process the pieces. */
2025 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
2027 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
2028 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2029 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2030 unsigned int adj_bytelen;
2031 rtx dest = dst;
2033 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2034 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2035 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2036 else
2037 adj_bytelen = bytelen;
2039 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2041 if (bytepos + adj_bytelen
2042 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2043 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2044 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2046 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2047 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2049 else
2051 machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2052 machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2054 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2056 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2057 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2059 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2060 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode));
2061 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2062 tmp_mode,
2063 bytepos),
2064 tmps[i]);
2065 dst = dest;
2067 else
2069 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2070 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode));
2071 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2072 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2074 break;
2078 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2079 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2081 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2082 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2083 if (
2084 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2085 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2086 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2087 #else
2088 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2089 #endif
2092 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2093 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2094 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2097 /* Make sure not to write past the end of the struct. */
2098 store_bit_field (dest,
2099 adj_bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2100 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, ssize * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1,
2101 VOIDmode, tmps[i]);
2104 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2105 else if (MEM_P (dest)
2106 && (!SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2107 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2108 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2109 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2110 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2112 else
2113 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2114 0, 0, mode, tmps[i]);
2117 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2118 if (orig_dst != dst)
2119 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2122 /* Return a form of X that does not use a PARALLEL. TYPE is the type
2123 of the value stored in X. */
2126 maybe_emit_group_store (rtx x, tree type)
2128 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
2129 gcc_checking_assert (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || GET_MODE (x) == mode);
2130 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
2132 rtx result = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2133 emit_group_store (result, x, type, int_size_in_bytes (type));
2134 return result;
2136 return x;
2139 /* Copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a register SRCREG into TARGET.
2141 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2143 void
2144 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx target, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2146 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2147 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2148 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2149 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2150 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (srcreg);
2151 machine_mode tmode = GET_MODE (target);
2152 machine_mode copy_mode;
2154 /* BLKmode registers created in the back-end shouldn't have survived. */
2155 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
2157 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2158 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2159 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2161 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2162 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2163 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2164 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2165 end of the register. */
2166 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2167 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2168 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2169 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2170 padding_correction
2171 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2173 /* We can use a single move if we have an exact mode for the size. */
2174 else if (MEM_P (target)
2175 && (!SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target))
2176 || MEM_ALIGN (target) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2177 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2179 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (target, mode, 0), srcreg);
2180 return;
2183 /* And if we additionally have the same mode for a register. */
2184 else if (REG_P (target)
2185 && GET_MODE (target) == mode
2186 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2188 emit_move_insn (target, srcreg);
2189 return;
2192 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2193 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2194 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2196 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2197 mode = word_mode;
2200 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2201 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2202 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2203 how it is computed.
2205 If the target lives in register, make sure not to select a copy mode
2206 larger than the mode of the register.
2208 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2209 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2210 time. */
2212 copy_mode = word_mode;
2213 if (MEM_P (target))
2215 machine_mode mem_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
2216 if (mem_mode != BLKmode)
2217 copy_mode = mem_mode;
2219 else if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2220 copy_mode = tmode;
2222 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2223 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2224 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2226 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2227 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2228 (the first time through). */
2229 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2230 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, mode);
2232 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2233 a word boundary. */
2234 if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2235 dst = target;
2236 else if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2237 dst = operand_subword (target, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, tmode);
2239 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2240 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2241 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
2242 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2243 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2244 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode));
2248 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE. Return the
2249 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
2251 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2254 copy_blkmode_to_reg (machine_mode mode, tree src)
2256 int i, n_regs;
2257 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
2258 unsigned int bitsize;
2259 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
2260 machine_mode dst_mode;
2262 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
2264 x = expand_normal (src);
2266 bytes = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
2267 if (bytes == 0)
2268 return NULL_RTX;
2270 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
2271 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
2272 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
2273 bits needed on the left side.
2275 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2276 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2277 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2278 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2279 end of the register. */
2280 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2281 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
2282 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2283 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2284 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2285 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2287 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2288 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
2289 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
2291 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
2292 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2293 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2294 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2296 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
2297 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2298 (the first time through). */
2299 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2300 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2302 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
2303 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
2304 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
2306 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
2307 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
2310 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
2311 boundary. */
2312 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2313 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
2315 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
2316 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
2317 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
2318 0, 0, word_mode,
2319 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
2320 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2321 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
2324 if (mode == BLKmode)
2326 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
2327 entire structure. */
2328 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2329 mode != VOIDmode;
2330 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2331 /* Have we found a large enough mode? */
2332 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= bytes)
2333 break;
2335 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
2336 gcc_assert (mode != VOIDmode);
2339 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
2340 dst_mode = word_mode;
2341 else
2342 dst_mode = mode;
2343 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
2345 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
2346 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
2348 if (mode != dst_mode)
2349 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
2351 return dst;
2354 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2355 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2357 void
2358 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
2360 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg));
2362 if (!HARD_REGISTER_P (reg))
2363 return;
2365 *call_fusage
2366 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2369 /* Add a CLOBBER expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2370 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2372 void
2373 clobber_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
2375 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2377 *call_fusage
2378 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2381 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2382 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2384 void
2385 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2387 int i;
2389 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2391 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2392 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2395 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2396 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2397 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2399 void
2400 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2402 int i;
2404 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2406 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2408 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2409 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2410 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2411 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
2412 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2416 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2417 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
2418 NULL otherwise. */
2420 static gimple
2421 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
2423 gimple def_stmt;
2425 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2426 return NULL;
2428 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2429 if (!def_stmt
2430 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
2431 return NULL;
2433 return def_stmt;
2436 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
2437 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2438 assigment and the class of the expresion on the RHS is CLASS. Return
2439 NULL otherwise. */
2441 static gimple
2442 get_def_for_expr_class (tree name, enum tree_code_class tclass)
2444 gimple def_stmt;
2446 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2447 return NULL;
2449 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2450 if (!def_stmt
2451 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)) != tclass)
2452 return NULL;
2454 return def_stmt;
2456 #endif
2459 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2460 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2461 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2462 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2463 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2464 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2467 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2468 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, machine_mode),
2469 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
2471 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
2472 unsigned int max_size;
2473 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2474 machine_mode mode;
2475 enum insn_code icode;
2476 int reverse;
2477 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
2478 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2480 if (len == 0)
2481 return 1;
2483 if (!targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align,
2484 memsetp
2485 ? SET_BY_PIECES
2486 : STORE_BY_PIECES,
2487 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
2488 return 0;
2490 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2492 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2493 successively smaller modes. */
2495 for (reverse = 0;
2496 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2497 reverse++)
2499 l = len;
2500 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2501 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
2503 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2505 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2506 break;
2508 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2509 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2510 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2512 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2514 while (l >= size)
2516 if (reverse)
2517 offset -= size;
2519 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2520 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst))
2521 return 0;
2523 if (!reverse)
2524 offset += size;
2526 l -= size;
2530 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2533 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2534 gcc_assert (!l);
2537 return 1;
2540 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2541 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2542 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2543 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2544 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2545 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2546 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2547 stpcpy. */
2550 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2551 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, machine_mode),
2552 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp, int endp)
2554 machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
2555 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2557 if (len == 0)
2559 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2560 return to;
2563 gcc_assert (targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p
2564 (len, align,
2565 memsetp
2566 ? SET_BY_PIECES
2567 : STORE_BY_PIECES,
2568 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()));
2570 data.constfun = constfun;
2571 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2572 data.len = len;
2573 data.to = to;
2574 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2575 if (endp)
2577 rtx to1;
2579 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2580 if (data.autinc_to)
2582 if (endp == 2)
2584 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2585 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2586 else
2587 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2588 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2589 data.to_addr,
2590 -1));
2592 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2593 data.offset);
2595 else
2597 if (endp == 2)
2598 --data.offset;
2599 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2601 return to1;
2603 else
2604 return data.to;
2607 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2608 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2610 static void
2611 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2613 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2615 if (len == 0)
2616 return;
2618 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2619 data.constfundata = NULL;
2620 data.len = len;
2621 data.to = to;
2622 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2625 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2626 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2628 static rtx
2629 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2630 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2631 machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2633 return const0_rtx;
2636 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2637 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2638 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2640 static void
2641 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2642 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2644 machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (data->to);
2645 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2646 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2647 enum insn_code icode;
2649 data->offset = 0;
2650 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2651 data->autinc_to
2652 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2653 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2655 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2656 data->reverse
2657 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2658 if (data->reverse)
2659 data->offset = data->len;
2661 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2662 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2663 and use post-increment if available. */
2664 if (!data->autinc_to
2665 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2667 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using.
2668 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
2669 USE_* macros below. */
2670 machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
2671 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2673 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2675 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2676 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2677 to_addr,
2678 data->len));
2679 data->autinc_to = 1;
2680 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2683 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2684 && ! data->autinc_to)
2686 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2687 data->autinc_to = 1;
2688 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2691 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2692 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2695 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2697 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2698 successively smaller modes. */
2700 while (max_size > 1 && data->len > 0)
2702 machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2704 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2705 break;
2707 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2708 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2709 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2711 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2714 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2715 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2718 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2719 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2720 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2722 static void
2723 store_by_pieces_2 (insn_gen_fn genfun, machine_mode mode,
2724 struct store_by_pieces_d *data)
2726 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2727 rtx to1, cst;
2729 while (data->len >= size)
2731 if (data->reverse)
2732 data->offset -= size;
2734 if (data->autinc_to)
2735 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2736 data->offset);
2737 else
2738 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2740 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2741 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2742 gen_int_mode (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size,
2743 GET_MODE (data->to_addr))));
2745 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2746 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2748 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2749 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2750 gen_int_mode (size,
2751 GET_MODE (data->to_addr))));
2753 if (! data->reverse)
2754 data->offset += size;
2756 data->len -= size;
2760 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2761 its length in bytes. */
2764 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2765 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
2766 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
2767 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
2768 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
2770 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
2771 unsigned int align;
2773 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2775 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2776 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2777 if (mode != BLKmode
2778 && CONST_INT_P (size)
2779 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2781 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
2782 if (zero != NULL)
2784 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
2785 return NULL;
2788 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
2790 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
2791 if (zero != NULL)
2793 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
2794 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
2795 return NULL;
2800 if (size == const0_rtx)
2801 return NULL;
2803 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
2805 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
2806 && targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (INTVAL (size), align,
2807 CLEAR_BY_PIECES,
2808 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
2809 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2810 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
2811 expected_align, expected_size,
2812 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size))
2814 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
2815 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
2816 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2817 else
2818 gcc_unreachable ();
2820 return NULL;
2824 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
2826 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
2827 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
2828 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
2829 else
2830 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
2831 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1, min, max, max);
2835 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2836 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2839 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
2841 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
2842 machine_mode size_mode;
2843 rtx retval;
2845 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2846 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2848 object = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (object, 0));
2850 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2851 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2852 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2854 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2855 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2856 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2857 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2858 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2860 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2861 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
2862 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
2863 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2864 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
2866 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2867 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
2868 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2870 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
2872 return retval;
2875 /* A subroutine of set_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2876 for the function we use for block clears. */
2878 tree block_clear_fn;
2880 void
2881 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2883 if (!block_clear_fn)
2885 tree fn, args;
2887 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2888 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2889 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2890 NULL_TREE);
2892 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2893 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2894 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2895 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2896 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2897 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
2898 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
2900 block_clear_fn = fn;
2903 if (asmspec)
2904 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2907 static tree
2908 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2910 static bool emitted_extern;
2912 if (!block_clear_fn)
2913 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2915 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2917 emitted_extern = true;
2918 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2921 return block_clear_fn;
2924 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
2926 bool
2927 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
2928 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
2929 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
2930 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
2931 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
2933 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2934 including more than one in the machine description unless
2935 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2937 machine_mode mode;
2939 if (expected_align < align)
2940 expected_align = align;
2941 if (expected_size != -1)
2943 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > max_size)
2944 expected_size = max_size;
2945 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
2946 expected_size = min_size;
2949 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2950 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2952 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
2954 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2955 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
2956 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
2957 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
2958 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
2959 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
2960 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2961 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2962 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2963 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
2964 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
2966 struct expand_operand ops[9];
2967 unsigned int nops;
2969 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
2970 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
2972 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
2973 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
2974 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
2975 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
2976 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2977 if (nops >= 6)
2979 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2980 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
2982 if (nops >= 8)
2984 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
2985 /* If we can not represent the maximal size,
2986 make parameter NULL. */
2987 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
2988 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
2989 else
2990 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
2992 if (nops == 9)
2994 /* If we can not represent the maximal size,
2995 make parameter NULL. */
2996 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
2997 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
2998 else
2999 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
3001 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
3002 return true;
3006 return false;
3010 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
3011 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
3013 void
3014 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
3016 machine_mode cmode;
3017 machine_mode imode;
3018 unsigned ibitsize;
3020 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
3022 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
3023 return;
3026 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
3027 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
3028 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
3030 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
3031 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
3032 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
3033 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
3034 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
3035 if (MEM_P (cplx))
3037 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
3038 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
3039 val);
3040 return;
3043 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
3044 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
3045 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
3046 correspond to TCmode. */
3047 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
3048 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
3049 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
3050 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
3051 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
3052 || (REG_P (cplx)
3053 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3054 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
3056 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
3057 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3058 if (part)
3060 emit_move_insn (part, val);
3061 return;
3063 else
3064 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
3065 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3068 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val);
3071 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
3072 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
3074 static rtx
3075 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
3077 machine_mode cmode, imode;
3078 unsigned ibitsize;
3080 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
3081 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
3083 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
3084 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
3085 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
3087 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
3088 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
3090 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
3091 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
3093 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
3094 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
3095 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3099 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
3100 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
3101 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
3102 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
3103 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
3104 if (MEM_P (cplx))
3105 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
3106 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3108 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
3109 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
3110 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
3111 correspond to TCmode. */
3112 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
3113 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
3114 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
3115 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
3116 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
3117 || (REG_P (cplx)
3118 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3119 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
3121 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
3122 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3123 if (ret)
3124 return ret;
3125 else
3126 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
3127 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3130 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
3131 true, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
3134 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
3135 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
3136 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
3137 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
3139 static rtx
3140 emit_move_change_mode (machine_mode new_mode,
3141 machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
3143 rtx ret;
3145 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3147 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
3148 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
3150 else if (MEM_P (x))
3152 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
3153 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
3154 if (reload_in_progress)
3156 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3157 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3158 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
3159 copy_replacements (x, ret);
3161 else
3162 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
3164 else
3166 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
3167 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
3168 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
3169 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
3170 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
3171 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
3172 if (force)
3173 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3174 else
3175 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3178 return ret;
3181 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
3182 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
3183 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
3185 static rtx_insn *
3186 emit_move_via_integer (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
3188 machine_mode imode;
3189 enum insn_code code;
3191 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
3192 imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
3193 if (imode == BLKmode)
3194 return NULL;
3196 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
3197 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
3198 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3199 return NULL;
3201 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
3202 if (x == NULL_RTX)
3203 return NULL;
3204 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3205 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3206 return NULL;
3207 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3210 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3211 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3214 emit_move_resolve_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3216 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3217 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
3218 rtx temp;
3220 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3221 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3222 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3223 #endif
3224 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3225 adjust = -adjust;
3226 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3228 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3229 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
3231 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3232 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (expr, 1)));
3233 val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
3234 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3235 val = -val;
3236 gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
3237 adjust = val;
3240 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3241 stack_pointer_delta. */
3242 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3243 gen_int_mode (adjust, Pmode), stack_pointer_rtx,
3244 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3245 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3246 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3248 switch (code)
3250 case PRE_INC:
3251 case PRE_DEC:
3252 case PRE_MODIFY:
3253 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3254 break;
3255 case POST_INC:
3256 case POST_DEC:
3257 case POST_MODIFY:
3258 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3259 break;
3260 default:
3261 gcc_unreachable ();
3264 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3267 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3268 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3269 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3271 rtx_insn *
3272 emit_move_complex_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3274 machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3275 bool imag_first;
3277 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3278 unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3280 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3281 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3282 if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
3284 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3285 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3287 #endif
3289 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3290 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3291 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3293 case PRE_DEC:
3294 case POST_DEC:
3295 imag_first = true;
3296 break;
3297 case PRE_INC:
3298 case POST_INC:
3299 imag_first = false;
3300 break;
3301 default:
3302 gcc_unreachable ();
3305 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3306 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3307 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3308 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3311 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3312 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3314 rtx_insn *
3315 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3317 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3318 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3319 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3320 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3321 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3322 emit_clobber (x);
3324 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3325 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3327 return get_last_insn ();
3330 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3331 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3333 static rtx_insn *
3334 emit_move_complex (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3336 bool try_int;
3338 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3339 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3340 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3341 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3343 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once, except
3344 for floating point where we favor moving as parts if this is easy. */
3345 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3346 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing
3347 && !(REG_P (x)
3348 && HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
3349 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (x)][mode] == 1)
3350 && !(REG_P (y)
3351 && HARD_REGISTER_P (y)
3352 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (y)][mode] == 1))
3353 try_int = false;
3354 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3355 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3356 try_int = false;
3357 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3358 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3359 try_int = true;
3360 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3361 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3362 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3363 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3364 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3365 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3366 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3367 try_int = true;
3368 else
3369 try_int = false;
3371 if (try_int)
3373 rtx_insn *ret;
3375 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3376 existing block move logic. */
3377 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3379 emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3380 BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
3381 return get_last_insn ();
3384 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3385 if (ret)
3386 return ret;
3389 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3392 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3393 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3395 static rtx_insn *
3396 emit_move_ccmode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3398 rtx_insn *ret;
3400 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3401 if (mode != CCmode)
3403 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3404 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3406 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3407 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3408 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3412 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3413 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3414 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3415 return ret;
3418 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3419 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3421 static bool
3422 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3424 machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
3425 int offset;
3426 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3427 return false;
3428 innermode = GET_MODE (op);
3429 innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3430 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
3431 /* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
3432 memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
3433 SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
3434 simplify_subreg. */
3435 if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
3436 && GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
3438 int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
3439 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3440 offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3441 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3442 offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
3444 if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
3445 || offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3446 return true;
3447 return false;
3450 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3451 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3452 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3453 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3455 static rtx_insn *
3456 emit_move_multi_word (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3458 rtx_insn *last_insn = 0;
3459 rtx_insn *seq;
3460 rtx inner;
3461 bool need_clobber;
3462 int i;
3464 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3466 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3467 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3468 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3469 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3471 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3472 is scheduled for replacement. */
3473 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3474 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3475 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3476 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3477 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3478 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3480 start_sequence ();
3482 need_clobber = false;
3483 for (i = 0;
3484 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3485 i++)
3487 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3488 rtx ypart;
3490 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3491 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3492 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3493 continue;
3495 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3497 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3498 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3499 be able to get a part of Y. */
3500 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3502 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3503 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3505 else if (ypart == 0)
3506 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3508 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3510 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3512 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3515 seq = get_insns ();
3516 end_sequence ();
3518 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3519 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3520 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3521 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3522 if (x != y
3523 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3524 && need_clobber != 0)
3525 emit_clobber (x);
3527 emit_insn (seq);
3529 return last_insn;
3532 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3533 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3534 are basically valid. */
3536 rtx_insn *
3537 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3539 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3540 enum insn_code code;
3542 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3544 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3545 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3546 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3548 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3549 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3550 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3552 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3553 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3555 rtx_insn *result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3557 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3558 if (result)
3559 return result;
3560 else
3561 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3564 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3565 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3567 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3568 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3569 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3570 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3571 if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
3573 rtx_insn *ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, lra_in_progress);
3575 if (ret)
3577 if (! lra_in_progress || recog (PATTERN (ret), ret, 0) >= 0)
3578 return ret;
3582 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3585 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3586 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3587 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3588 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3590 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3592 rtx_insn *
3593 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3595 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3596 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3597 rtx_insn *last_insn;
3598 rtx set;
3600 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3601 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3603 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3605 if (optimize
3606 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3607 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3608 return last_insn;
3610 y_cst = y;
3612 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
3614 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3616 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3617 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3618 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3619 if (!y)
3620 y = y_cst;
3621 else
3622 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3626 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3627 for the machine. */
3628 if (MEM_P (x)
3629 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3630 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3631 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3632 x = validize_mem (x);
3634 if (MEM_P (y)
3635 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3636 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3637 y = validize_mem (y);
3639 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3641 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3643 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3644 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3645 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3646 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3647 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
3649 return last_insn;
3652 /* Generate the body of an instruction to copy Y into X.
3653 It may be a list of insns, if one insn isn't enough. */
3656 gen_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3658 rtx_insn *seq;
3660 start_sequence ();
3661 emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3662 seq = get_insns ();
3663 end_sequence ();
3664 return seq;
3667 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3668 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3669 move as an extension. */
3671 static rtx_insn *
3672 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3674 machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3675 machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3676 machine_mode srcmode;
3677 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3678 int oldcost, newcost;
3679 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3681 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3683 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
3684 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, speed);
3685 else
3686 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), speed);
3688 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3689 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3690 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3692 enum insn_code ic;
3693 rtx trunc_y;
3694 rtx_insn *last_insn;
3696 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3697 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3698 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3699 continue;
3701 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3702 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3703 continue;
3705 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3707 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
3709 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3710 the extension. */
3711 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
3712 continue;
3713 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3714 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3715 speed);
3716 if (oldcost < newcost)
3717 continue;
3719 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3721 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3722 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3723 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3724 speed);
3725 if (oldcost < newcost)
3726 continue;
3727 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3729 else
3730 continue;
3732 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3733 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3734 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3735 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3737 /* If x is a hard register, perform the extension into a pseudo,
3738 so that e.g. stack realignment code is aware of it. */
3739 rtx target = x;
3740 if (REG_P (x) && HARD_REGISTER_P (x))
3741 target = gen_reg_rtx (dstmode);
3743 emit_unop_insn (ic, target, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3744 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3746 if (REG_P (target))
3747 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3749 if (target != x)
3750 return emit_move_insn (x, target);
3751 return last_insn;
3754 return NULL;
3757 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3759 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3760 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3761 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3763 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3764 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3765 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3768 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3770 rtx temp;
3772 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3773 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3774 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (Pmode, size, extra));
3775 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
3776 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3777 else
3779 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3780 if (extra != 0)
3781 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp,
3782 gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode),
3783 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3784 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3787 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3788 if (0)
3789 #else
3790 if (1)
3791 #endif
3793 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3794 if (extra != 0 && below)
3795 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, temp, extra);
3797 else
3799 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3800 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3801 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3802 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3803 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3804 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, size,
3805 extra)));
3806 else
3807 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3808 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3811 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3814 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
3816 static rtx
3817 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
3819 if (MEM_P (mem))
3821 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3822 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
3823 return XEXP (addr, 0);
3825 return NULL;
3828 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
3829 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
3830 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
3831 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
3832 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
3834 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
3835 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
3836 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
3837 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
3838 (4) A call_pop insn,
3839 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
3841 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
3842 except for noreturn calls.
3844 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
3845 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
3846 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is INT_MIN. */
3848 HOST_WIDE_INT
3849 find_args_size_adjust (rtx_insn *insn)
3851 rtx dest, set, pat;
3852 int i;
3854 pat = PATTERN (insn);
3855 set = NULL;
3857 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
3858 if (CALL_P (insn))
3860 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
3861 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
3862 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
3863 return 0;
3865 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
3866 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
3867 usually last, so search from the end. */
3868 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
3870 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3871 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3872 continue;
3873 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3874 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3875 break;
3877 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
3878 if (i == 0)
3879 return 0;
3880 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
3881 as if it was a standalone insn. */
3883 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
3884 set = pat;
3885 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
3887 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
3889 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
3890 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
3891 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
3892 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
3893 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3895 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3896 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3897 continue;
3898 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3899 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3900 break;
3902 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
3903 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
3904 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3905 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3907 if (i < 0)
3908 return 0;
3910 else
3911 return 0;
3913 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3915 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
3916 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
3918 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
3919 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
3920 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
3921 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
3922 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
3923 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
3924 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)))
3925 return INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
3926 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
3927 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
3928 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
3929 return 0;
3930 else
3931 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
3933 else
3935 rtx mem, addr;
3937 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
3938 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3940 mem = dest;
3941 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3942 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3944 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3945 mem = SET_SRC (set);
3946 else
3947 return 0;
3949 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3950 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
3952 case PRE_INC:
3953 case POST_INC:
3954 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3955 case PRE_DEC:
3956 case POST_DEC:
3957 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3958 case PRE_MODIFY:
3959 case POST_MODIFY:
3960 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
3961 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
3962 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
3963 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)));
3964 return INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
3965 default:
3966 gcc_unreachable ();
3972 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx_insn *prev, rtx_insn *last, int end_args_size)
3974 int args_size = end_args_size;
3975 bool saw_unknown = false;
3976 rtx_insn *insn;
3978 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
3980 HOST_WIDE_INT this_delta;
3982 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3983 continue;
3985 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
3986 if (this_delta == 0)
3988 if (!CALL_P (insn)
3989 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3990 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
3991 continue;
3994 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
3995 if (this_delta == HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
3996 saw_unknown = true;
3998 add_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (args_size));
3999 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4000 this_delta = -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) this_delta;
4001 #endif
4002 args_size -= this_delta;
4005 return saw_unknown ? INT_MIN : args_size;
4008 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4009 /* Emit single push insn. */
4011 static void
4012 emit_single_push_insn_1 (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
4014 rtx dest_addr;
4015 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4016 rtx dest;
4017 enum insn_code icode;
4019 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4020 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
4021 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
4022 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
4023 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4025 struct expand_operand ops[1];
4027 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
4028 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
4029 return;
4031 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
4032 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
4033 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
4034 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
4035 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
4036 access to type. */
4037 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
4039 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4040 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
4042 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
4043 expand_binop (Pmode,
4044 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4045 sub_optab,
4046 #else
4047 add_optab,
4048 #endif
4049 stack_pointer_rtx,
4050 gen_int_mode (rounded_size, Pmode),
4051 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
4053 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
4054 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4055 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4056 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
4057 previous value. */
4058 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
4059 #else
4060 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
4061 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
4062 previous value. */
4063 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
4064 #endif
4065 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
4066 gen_int_mode (offset, Pmode));
4068 else
4070 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4071 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
4072 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
4073 gen_int_mode (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size,
4074 Pmode));
4075 #else
4076 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
4077 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
4078 gen_int_mode (rounded_size, Pmode));
4079 #endif
4080 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
4083 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
4085 if (type != 0)
4087 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
4089 if (cfun->tail_call_marked)
4090 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
4091 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
4092 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
4093 of sibling calls. */
4094 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
4096 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4099 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
4101 static void
4102 emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
4104 int delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
4105 rtx_insn *prev = get_last_insn ();
4106 rtx_insn *last;
4108 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
4110 last = get_last_insn ();
4112 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
4113 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
4115 add_reg_note (last, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (stack_pointer_delta));
4116 return;
4119 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
4120 gcc_assert (delta == INT_MIN || delta == old_delta);
4122 #endif
4124 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
4125 type TYPE.
4126 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
4127 carry mode info).
4128 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
4129 needed only if X is BLKmode.
4131 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
4133 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
4134 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
4135 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
4136 REG must be a hard register in this case.
4137 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
4138 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
4139 registers.
4141 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
4142 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
4144 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
4145 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
4146 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
4147 argument block has not been preallocated.
4149 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
4151 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
4152 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
4153 of bytes required. */
4155 void
4156 emit_push_insn (rtx x, machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
4157 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
4158 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
4159 rtx alignment_pad)
4161 rtx xinner;
4162 enum direction stack_direction
4163 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4164 = downward;
4165 #else
4166 = upward;
4167 #endif
4169 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
4170 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
4171 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
4172 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
4174 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
4175 FIXME: why? */
4176 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4177 if (where_pad != none)
4178 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
4180 xinner = x;
4182 if (mode == BLKmode
4183 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
4185 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
4187 rtx temp;
4188 int used;
4189 int offset;
4190 int skip;
4192 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4193 used = partial - offset;
4195 if (mode != BLKmode)
4197 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
4198 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
4199 necessary. */
4200 size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4201 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
4203 temp = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
4204 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
4205 xinner = temp;
4209 gcc_assert (size);
4211 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
4212 because registers will take care of them. */
4214 if (partial != 0)
4215 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
4217 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4218 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4219 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4220 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4221 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
4223 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4224 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
4225 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
4226 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
4227 if (args_addr == 0
4228 && PUSH_ARGS
4229 && CONST_INT_P (size)
4230 && skip == 0
4231 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
4232 && can_move_by_pieces ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align)
4233 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
4234 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
4235 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
4236 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
4237 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
4238 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
4239 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
4240 && (HOST_WIDE_INT) PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
4242 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4243 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4244 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4245 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4246 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4247 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4249 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
4251 else
4252 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
4254 rtx target;
4256 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
4257 to the address of that space. */
4259 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
4260 if (partial != 0)
4262 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
4263 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
4264 else
4265 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
4266 gen_int_mode (used, GET_MODE (size)),
4267 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4270 /* Get the address of the stack space.
4271 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
4272 A single stack adjust will do. */
4273 if (! args_addr)
4275 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
4276 extra = 0;
4278 else if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4279 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4280 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4281 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4282 else
4283 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4284 plus_constant (Pmode,
4285 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
4286 args_addr,
4287 args_so_far),
4288 skip));
4290 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
4292 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
4293 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
4294 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
4296 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
4297 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
4298 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4301 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
4303 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4304 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4305 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4306 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4307 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4308 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4309 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4310 set_mem_align (target, align);
4312 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
4315 else if (partial > 0)
4317 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
4319 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4320 int i;
4321 int not_stack;
4322 /* # bytes of start of argument
4323 that we must make space for but need not store. */
4324 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4325 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4326 int skip;
4328 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4329 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4330 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4331 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4332 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4333 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4335 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4336 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4337 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4338 if (args_addr == 0)
4339 offset = 0;
4341 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4342 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
4343 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4344 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4346 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4347 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4348 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4349 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4350 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4352 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4353 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4355 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4356 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4357 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4358 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4359 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4361 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4362 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4363 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4364 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4365 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4366 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4367 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4368 0, args_addr,
4369 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4370 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4371 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
4373 else
4375 rtx addr;
4376 rtx dest;
4378 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4379 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4380 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4381 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4382 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4383 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4385 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4386 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4387 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4388 else
4389 #endif
4391 if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4392 addr
4393 = memory_address (mode,
4394 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4395 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4396 else
4397 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
4398 args_so_far));
4399 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4401 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4402 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4403 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4404 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4405 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4406 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4407 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4408 set_mem_align (dest, align);
4410 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4414 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
4415 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
4416 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
4417 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4419 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4420 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4421 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4422 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4423 else
4425 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4426 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
4430 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4431 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4433 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4434 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4437 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4438 operations. */
4440 static rtx
4441 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4443 return (optimize
4444 || x == 0
4445 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4446 || !REG_P (x)
4447 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4448 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4449 ? 0 : x);
4452 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
4453 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
4454 and there's nothing else to do. */
4456 static bool
4457 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4458 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4459 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
4460 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
4461 machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4462 tree to, tree src)
4464 machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4465 unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4466 tree op0, op1;
4467 rtx value, result;
4468 optab binop;
4469 gimple srcstmt;
4470 enum tree_code code;
4472 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4473 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4474 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4475 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4476 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4477 return false;
4479 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4480 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
4481 return false;
4482 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4483 return false;
4485 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
4486 if (!srcstmt
4487 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
4488 return false;
4490 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
4492 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
4494 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
4495 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
4496 be from a bitfield load. */
4497 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
4499 gimple op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
4501 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
4502 should be a bitfield. */
4503 if (!op0stmt
4504 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
4505 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
4506 return false;
4507 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
4510 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
4512 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4513 return false;
4515 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4517 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4519 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4520 str_mode = word_mode;
4521 str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
4522 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4523 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
4524 if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
4525 return false;
4526 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4528 offset1 = bitpos;
4529 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4530 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4531 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4533 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4534 return false;
4536 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4537 will likely generate better code. */
4538 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4539 return false;
4541 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4542 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4543 return false;
4545 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4546 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4548 switch (code)
4550 case PLUS_EXPR:
4551 case MINUS_EXPR:
4552 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4553 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4554 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4555 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4556 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4557 can be added later. */
4558 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
4559 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4560 break;
4562 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4563 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4564 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4565 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4567 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4568 we can alias adjacent data. */
4569 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4571 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4572 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4573 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4576 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4577 if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4579 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4580 binop = xor_optab;
4582 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4583 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4584 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4585 if (result != str_rtx)
4586 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4587 return true;
4589 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4590 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4591 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4592 break;
4593 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4594 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4595 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4596 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4598 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4599 we can alias adjacent data. */
4600 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4602 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4603 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4604 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4607 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4608 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4610 rtx mask = gen_int_mode (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1,
4611 str_mode);
4612 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, mask, NULL_RTX);
4614 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4615 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4616 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4617 if (result != str_rtx)
4618 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4619 return true;
4621 default:
4622 break;
4625 return false;
4628 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
4629 considered one memory location.
4631 Given a COMPONENT_REF EXP at position (BITPOS, OFFSET), this function
4632 returns the bit range of consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF
4633 belongs. The values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. *BITPOS
4634 and *OFFSET may be adjusted in the process.
4636 If the access does not need to be restricted, 0 is returned in both
4637 *BITSTART and *BITEND. */
4639 static void
4640 get_bit_range (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitstart,
4641 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitend,
4642 tree exp,
4643 HOST_WIDE_INT *bitpos,
4644 tree *offset)
4646 HOST_WIDE_INT bitoffset;
4647 tree field, repr;
4649 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
4651 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4652 repr = DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE (field);
4653 /* If we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE there is no
4654 need to limit the range we can access. */
4655 if (!repr)
4657 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4658 return;
4661 /* If we have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE but the enclosing record is
4662 part of a larger bit field, then the representative does not serve any
4663 useful purpose. This can occur in Ada. */
4664 if (handled_component_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
4666 machine_mode rmode;
4667 HOST_WIDE_INT rbitsize, rbitpos;
4668 tree roffset;
4669 int unsignedp;
4670 int volatilep = 0;
4671 get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &rbitsize, &rbitpos,
4672 &roffset, &rmode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
4673 if ((rbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) != 0)
4675 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4676 return;
4680 /* Compute the adjustment to bitpos from the offset of the field
4681 relative to the representative. DECL_FIELD_OFFSET of field and
4682 repr are the same by construction if they are not constants,
4683 see finish_bitfield_layout. */
4684 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field))
4685 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr)))
4686 bitoffset = (tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field))
4687 - tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr))) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4688 else
4689 bitoffset = 0;
4690 bitoffset += (tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field))
4691 - tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (repr)));
4693 /* If the adjustment is larger than bitpos, we would have a negative bit
4694 position for the lower bound and this may wreak havoc later. Adjust
4695 offset and bitpos to make the lower bound non-negative in that case. */
4696 if (bitoffset > *bitpos)
4698 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust = bitoffset - *bitpos;
4699 gcc_assert ((adjust % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
4701 *bitpos += adjust;
4702 if (*offset == NULL_TREE)
4703 *offset = size_int (-adjust / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4704 else
4705 *offset
4706 = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *offset, size_int (adjust / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4707 *bitstart = 0;
4709 else
4710 *bitstart = *bitpos - bitoffset;
4712 *bitend = *bitstart + tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (repr)) - 1;
4715 /* Returns true if ADDR is an ADDR_EXPR of a DECL that does not reside
4716 in memory and has non-BLKmode. DECL_RTL must not be a MEM; if
4717 DECL_RTL was not set yet, return NORTL. */
4719 static inline bool
4720 addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p_1 (tree addr, bool nortl)
4722 if (TREE_CODE (addr) != ADDR_EXPR)
4723 return false;
4725 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (addr, 0);
4727 if (!DECL_P (base)
4728 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
4729 || DECL_MODE (base) == BLKmode)
4730 return false;
4732 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (base))
4733 return nortl;
4735 return (!MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
4738 /* Returns true if the MEM_REF REF refers to an object that does not
4739 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
4741 static inline bool
4742 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
4744 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
4745 return addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p_1 (base, false);
4748 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
4749 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
4751 void
4752 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
4754 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4755 rtx result;
4756 machine_mode mode;
4757 unsigned int align;
4758 enum insn_code icode;
4760 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4761 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4763 expand_normal (from);
4764 return;
4767 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
4768 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
4769 return;
4771 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
4772 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
4773 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4774 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4775 && mode != BLKmode
4776 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
4777 && ((align = get_object_alignment (to))
4778 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4779 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4780 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4781 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align)))
4783 rtx reg, mem;
4785 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4786 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
4787 mem = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4789 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4791 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4793 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4794 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
4795 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4796 would silently be omitted. */
4797 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4799 else
4800 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0, 0, 0, mode, reg);
4801 return;
4804 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4805 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4806 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4807 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4808 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
4809 if (handled_component_p (to)
4810 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4811 && mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to))
4812 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4814 machine_mode mode1;
4815 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4816 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start = 0;
4817 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end = 0;
4818 tree offset;
4819 int unsignedp;
4820 int volatilep = 0;
4821 tree tem;
4823 push_temp_slots ();
4824 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4825 &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4827 /* Make sure bitpos is not negative, it can wreak havoc later. */
4828 if (bitpos < 0)
4830 gcc_assert (offset == NULL_TREE);
4831 offset = size_int (bitpos >> (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
4832 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT)));
4833 bitpos &= BITS_PER_UNIT - 1;
4836 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
4837 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4838 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end, to, &bitpos, &offset);
4839 /* The C++ memory model naturally applies to byte-aligned fields.
4840 However, if we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE but BITPOS or
4841 BITSIZE are not byte-aligned, there is no need to limit the range
4842 we can access. This can occur with packed structures in Ada. */
4843 else if (bitsize > 0
4844 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
4845 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
4847 bitregion_start = bitpos;
4848 bitregion_end = bitpos + bitsize - 1;
4851 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4853 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
4854 field's mode, not the computed mode.
4855 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
4856 use BLKmode for it instead. */
4857 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4859 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
4860 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
4861 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
4862 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
4865 if (offset != 0)
4867 machine_mode address_mode;
4868 rtx offset_rtx;
4870 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
4872 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
4873 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
4874 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
4875 expand_builtin_trap ();
4876 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
4879 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4880 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
4881 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
4882 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4884 /* If we have an expression in OFFSET_RTX and a non-zero
4885 byte offset in BITPOS, adding the byte offset before the
4886 OFFSET_RTX results in better intermediate code, which makes
4887 later rtl optimization passes perform better.
4889 We prefer intermediate code like this:
4891 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x18
4892 [r124:DI]=r121:DI
4894 ... instead of ...
4896 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x10
4897 [r124:DI+0x8]=r121:DI
4899 This is only done for aligned data values, as these can
4900 be expected to result in single move instructions. */
4901 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4902 && bitpos != 0
4903 && bitsize > 0
4904 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4905 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4906 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4908 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4909 bitregion_start = 0;
4910 if (bitregion_end >= (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos)
4911 bitregion_end -= bitpos;
4912 bitpos = 0;
4915 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4916 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
4917 offset));
4920 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
4921 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
4922 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
4923 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
4924 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
4925 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos
4926 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx)))
4928 expand_normal (from);
4929 result = NULL;
4931 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
4932 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
4934 unsigned short mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx));
4935 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)))
4936 && bitpos == 0
4937 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4938 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal);
4939 else if (bitsize == mode_bitsize / 2
4940 && (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == mode_bitsize / 2))
4941 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false,
4942 nontemporal);
4943 else if (bitpos + bitsize <= mode_bitsize / 2)
4944 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
4945 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4946 mode1, from,
4947 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4948 else if (bitpos >= mode_bitsize / 2)
4949 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
4950 bitpos - mode_bitsize / 2,
4951 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4952 mode1, from,
4953 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4954 else if (bitpos == 0 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4956 rtx from_rtx;
4957 result = expand_normal (from);
4958 from_rtx = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), result,
4959 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)), 0);
4960 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
4961 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
4962 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
4963 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
4965 else
4967 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
4968 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
4969 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false);
4970 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true);
4971 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
4972 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4973 mode1, from,
4974 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4975 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
4976 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
4979 else
4981 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4983 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4984 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4985 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4986 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4987 if (volatilep)
4988 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4991 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
4992 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4993 mode1,
4994 to_rtx, to, from))
4995 result = NULL;
4996 else
4997 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
4998 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4999 mode1, from,
5000 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
5003 if (result)
5004 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5005 pop_temp_slots ();
5006 return;
5009 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
5010 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
5011 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
5012 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
5013 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
5015 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
5016 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
5017 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
5018 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
5019 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
5020 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
5021 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
5022 && ! (((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL
5023 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
5024 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
5025 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
5026 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
5028 rtx value;
5029 rtx bounds;
5031 push_temp_slots ();
5032 value = expand_normal (from);
5034 /* Split value and bounds to store them separately. */
5035 chkp_split_slot (value, &value, &bounds);
5037 if (to_rtx == 0)
5038 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5040 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5041 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5042 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
5044 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
5045 emit_group_move (to_rtx, value);
5046 else
5047 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
5048 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5050 else if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
5051 emit_group_store (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
5052 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5053 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
5055 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
5056 if (REG_P (value))
5057 copy_blkmode_from_reg (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from));
5058 else
5059 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5061 else
5063 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
5064 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
5065 (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value,
5066 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
5068 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
5071 /* Store bounds if required. */
5072 if (bounds
5073 && (BOUNDED_P (to) || chkp_type_has_pointer (TREE_TYPE (to))))
5075 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
5076 chkp_emit_bounds_store (bounds, value, to_rtx);
5079 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5080 pop_temp_slots ();
5081 return;
5084 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
5085 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5087 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
5088 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
5089 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
5091 rtx temp;
5093 push_temp_slots ();
5095 /* If the source is itself a return value, it still is in a pseudo at
5096 this point so we can move it back to the return register directly. */
5097 if (REG_P (to_rtx)
5098 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode
5099 && TREE_CODE (from) != CALL_EXPR)
5100 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
5101 else
5102 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
5104 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5105 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5106 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
5108 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5109 emit_group_move (to_rtx, temp);
5110 else
5111 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
5112 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
5114 else if (temp)
5115 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
5117 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5118 pop_temp_slots ();
5119 return;
5122 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
5123 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
5124 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
5125 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
5126 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
5127 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
5128 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
5129 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
5130 && cfun->returns_struct
5131 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
5133 rtx from_rtx, size;
5135 push_temp_slots ();
5136 size = expr_size (from);
5137 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
5139 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5140 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
5141 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
5142 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5143 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
5144 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5146 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5147 pop_temp_slots ();
5148 return;
5151 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
5153 push_temp_slots ();
5154 result = store_expr_with_bounds (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, to);
5155 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5156 pop_temp_slots ();
5157 return;
5160 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
5161 succeeded, false otherwise. */
5163 bool
5164 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
5166 struct expand_operand ops[2];
5167 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
5168 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
5170 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
5171 return false;
5173 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
5174 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
5175 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
5178 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
5179 and storing the value into TARGET.
5181 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
5182 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
5183 because C has no operators that could combine two different
5184 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
5185 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
5186 be more thorough?
5188 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
5189 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
5191 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction.
5193 If BTARGET is not NULL then computed bounds of EXP are
5194 associated with BTARGET. */
5197 store_expr_with_bounds (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p,
5198 bool nontemporal, tree btarget)
5200 rtx temp;
5201 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
5202 location_t loc = curr_insn_location ();
5204 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5206 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
5207 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
5208 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
5209 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
5210 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5211 return NULL_RTX;
5213 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
5215 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
5216 part. */
5217 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
5218 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5219 return store_expr_with_bounds (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
5220 call_param_p, nontemporal, btarget);
5222 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5224 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
5225 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
5226 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
5227 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
5229 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), *lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
5231 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5232 NO_DEFER_POP;
5233 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1, -1);
5234 store_expr_with_bounds (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5235 nontemporal, btarget);
5236 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
5237 emit_barrier ();
5238 emit_label (lab1);
5239 store_expr_with_bounds (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
5240 nontemporal, btarget);
5241 emit_label (lab2);
5242 OK_DEFER_POP;
5244 return NULL_RTX;
5246 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
5247 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
5248 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
5249 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
5250 expression. */
5252 rtx inner_target = 0;
5254 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
5255 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
5256 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
5257 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
5258 since then the conversion might involve more than just
5259 converting modes. */
5260 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5261 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
5262 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
5263 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5265 if (!SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (target,
5266 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
5268 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
5269 version, so use the mode instead. */
5270 tree ntype
5271 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
5272 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5273 if (ntype == NULL)
5274 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5275 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5276 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5278 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
5281 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5282 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5283 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target)),
5284 exp);
5286 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
5289 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
5290 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5292 /* Handle bounds returned by call. */
5293 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
5295 rtx bounds;
5296 chkp_split_slot (temp, &temp, &bounds);
5297 if (bounds && btarget)
5299 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (btarget) == SSA_NAME);
5300 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.load_returned_bounds (bounds);
5301 chkp_set_rtl_bounds (btarget, tmp);
5305 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
5306 sure that we properly convert it. */
5307 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5309 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5310 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5311 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5312 GET_MODE (target), temp,
5313 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5316 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
5317 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
5319 return NULL_RTX;
5321 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5322 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5323 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5324 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5325 == STRING_CST
5326 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
5327 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
5328 && MEM_P (target))
5330 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
5331 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
5332 rtx dest_mem;
5333 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5334 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5336 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
5337 if (exp_len <= 0)
5338 goto normal_expr;
5340 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
5341 goto normal_expr;
5343 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str));
5344 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1)
5345 goto normal_expr;
5347 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
5348 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0
5349 && TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)[TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1] == '\0')
5351 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
5352 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
5354 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
5355 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5356 CONST_CAST (char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5357 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5358 goto normal_expr;
5360 dest_mem = target;
5362 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
5363 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5364 CONST_CAST (char *,
5365 TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5366 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
5367 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
5368 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
5369 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
5370 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
5371 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5372 return NULL_RTX;
5374 else
5376 rtx tmp_target;
5378 normal_expr:
5379 /* If we want to use a nontemporal store, force the value to
5380 register first. */
5381 tmp_target = nontemporal ? NULL_RTX : target;
5382 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
5383 (call_param_p
5384 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
5385 &alt_rtl, false);
5387 /* Handle bounds returned by call. */
5388 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
5390 rtx bounds;
5391 chkp_split_slot (temp, &temp, &bounds);
5392 if (bounds && btarget)
5394 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (btarget) == SSA_NAME);
5395 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.load_returned_bounds (bounds);
5396 chkp_set_rtl_bounds (btarget, tmp);
5401 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
5402 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
5403 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE or CONST_WIDE_INT and we want
5404 only a word-sized value. */
5405 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
5406 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5407 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5408 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5409 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5411 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
5412 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
5413 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
5414 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
5415 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
5417 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
5418 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
5419 two cases:
5420 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
5421 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
5422 to == .
5423 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
5424 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
5425 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
5426 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
5427 of volatile memory references. */
5429 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
5430 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
5431 || side_effects_p (target))))
5432 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5433 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
5434 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
5435 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
5436 && !(alt_rtl
5437 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
5438 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
5439 && !side_effects_p (target))
5440 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
5441 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
5442 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
5443 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
5444 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
5446 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target) && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
5448 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5450 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
5451 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
5452 copy_blkmode_from_reg (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
5453 else
5454 store_bit_field (target,
5455 INTVAL (expr_size (exp)) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5456 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp);
5458 else
5459 convert_move (target, temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5462 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
5464 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
5465 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
5466 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
5467 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
5468 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
5470 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
5471 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
5472 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
5473 (call_param_p
5474 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5475 else
5477 machine_mode pointer_mode
5478 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5479 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (target);
5481 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
5482 tree copy_size
5483 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
5484 make_tree (sizetype, size),
5485 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
5486 rtx copy_size_rtx
5487 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
5488 (call_param_p
5489 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
5490 rtx_code_label *label = 0;
5492 /* Copy that much. */
5493 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
5494 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5495 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
5496 (call_param_p
5497 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5499 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
5500 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
5501 if (CONST_INT_P (copy_size_rtx))
5503 size = plus_constant (address_mode, size,
5504 -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5505 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
5506 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5508 else
5510 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
5511 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
5512 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5514 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
5515 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
5516 copy_size_rtx,
5517 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5519 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
5520 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
5521 label = gen_label_rtx ();
5522 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
5523 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
5526 if (size != const0_rtx)
5527 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5529 if (label)
5530 emit_label (label);
5533 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5534 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5535 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
5537 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5538 emit_group_move (target, temp);
5539 else
5540 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5541 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5543 else if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5544 emit_group_store (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5545 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5546 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5547 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5548 (call_param_p
5549 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5550 /* If we emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to do. */
5551 else if (nontemporal && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
5553 else
5555 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
5556 if (temp != target)
5557 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
5561 return NULL_RTX;
5564 /* Same as store_expr_with_bounds but ignoring bounds of EXP. */
5566 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p, bool nontemporal)
5568 return store_expr_with_bounds (exp, target, call_param_p, nontemporal, NULL);
5571 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
5573 static bool
5574 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
5576 const_tree tf;
5578 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5579 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5580 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5581 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5582 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5583 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5584 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5585 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
5588 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
5589 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
5590 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
5592 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
5594 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5595 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
5597 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5599 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5601 tree nelts;
5603 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
5604 if (nelts && tree_fits_uhwi_p (nelts))
5606 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5608 n = tree_to_uhwi (nelts) + 1;
5609 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
5610 return n;
5611 else
5612 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5614 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
5617 case RECORD_TYPE:
5619 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5620 tree f;
5622 n = 0;
5623 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5624 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5626 if (!for_ctor_p)
5627 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5628 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
5629 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
5630 to be initialized. */
5631 n += 1;
5634 return n;
5637 case UNION_TYPE:
5638 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5640 tree f;
5641 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
5643 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
5644 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
5645 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
5646 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
5647 of the fields. */
5648 n = 1;
5649 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5650 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5652 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5653 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
5654 scalar for the rest. */
5655 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
5656 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
5657 m++;
5658 if (n < m)
5659 n = m;
5661 return n;
5664 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
5665 return 2;
5667 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5668 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5670 case INTEGER_TYPE:
5671 case REAL_TYPE:
5672 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
5673 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
5674 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
5675 case POINTER_TYPE:
5676 case OFFSET_TYPE:
5677 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
5678 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
5679 return 1;
5681 case ERROR_MARK:
5682 return 0;
5684 case VOID_TYPE:
5685 case METHOD_TYPE:
5686 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
5687 case LANG_TYPE:
5688 default:
5689 gcc_unreachable ();
5693 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
5695 static bool
5696 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5697 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5699 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5700 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
5701 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
5703 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
5704 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
5705 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
5706 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
5707 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
5709 nz_elts = 0;
5710 init_elts = 0;
5711 num_fields = 0;
5712 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
5714 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
5716 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
5718 if (purpose && TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
5720 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
5721 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
5723 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index) && tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
5724 mult = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
5725 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
5727 num_fields += mult;
5728 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5730 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
5732 case CONSTRUCTOR:
5734 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
5736 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic,
5737 p_complete);
5739 nz_elts += mult * nz;
5740 init_elts += mult * ic;
5742 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5743 const_p = const_elt_p;
5745 break;
5747 case INTEGER_CST:
5748 case REAL_CST:
5749 case FIXED_CST:
5750 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
5751 nz_elts += mult;
5752 init_elts += mult;
5753 break;
5755 case STRING_CST:
5756 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5757 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5758 break;
5760 case COMPLEX_CST:
5761 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
5762 nz_elts += mult;
5763 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
5764 nz_elts += mult;
5765 init_elts += mult;
5766 break;
5768 case VECTOR_CST:
5770 unsigned i;
5771 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (value); ++i)
5773 tree v = VECTOR_CST_ELT (value, i);
5774 if (!initializer_zerop (v))
5775 nz_elts += mult;
5776 init_elts += mult;
5779 break;
5781 default:
5783 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
5784 nz_elts += mult * tc;
5785 init_elts += mult * tc;
5787 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5788 const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, elt_type)
5789 != NULL_TREE;
5791 break;
5795 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
5796 num_fields, elt_type))
5797 *p_complete = false;
5799 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
5800 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
5802 return const_p;
5805 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
5806 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
5807 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
5808 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
5809 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
5810 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
5811 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
5812 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
5814 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
5815 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
5817 bool
5818 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5819 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5821 *p_nz_elts = 0;
5822 *p_init_elts = 0;
5823 *p_complete = true;
5825 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_init_elts, p_complete);
5828 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
5829 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
5830 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
5831 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
5832 as a whole. */
5834 bool
5835 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
5836 const_tree last_type)
5838 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5839 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5841 if (num_elts == 0)
5842 return false;
5844 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
5846 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
5847 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
5848 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
5849 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
5850 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
5853 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
5856 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
5858 static int
5859 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5861 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5863 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5864 bool complete_p;
5866 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5867 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
5870 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5873 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
5875 static int
5876 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5878 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5880 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5881 bool complete_p;
5883 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5884 return nz_elts == 0;
5887 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5890 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
5891 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
5892 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
5893 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
5895 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
5896 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
5897 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
5898 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
5900 static void
5901 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
5902 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, machine_mode mode,
5903 tree exp, int cleared, alias_set_type alias_set)
5905 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
5906 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
5907 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
5908 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5909 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5910 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
5911 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
5912 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
5913 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
5915 if (MEM_P (target))
5916 target
5917 = adjust_address (target,
5918 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5919 || 0 != (bitpos
5920 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
5921 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5924 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
5925 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5926 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
5928 target = copy_rtx (target);
5929 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
5932 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5934 else
5935 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0, mode, exp, alias_set, false);
5939 /* Returns the number of FIELD_DECLs in TYPE. */
5941 static int
5942 fields_length (const_tree type)
5944 tree t = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
5945 int count = 0;
5947 for (; t; t = DECL_CHAIN (t))
5948 if (TREE_CODE (t) == FIELD_DECL)
5949 ++count;
5951 return count;
5955 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
5956 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
5957 safe_from_p has been called.
5958 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
5959 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
5960 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
5961 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
5963 static void
5964 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5966 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5967 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5968 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
5969 #endif
5971 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5973 case RECORD_TYPE:
5974 case UNION_TYPE:
5975 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5977 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5978 tree field, value;
5980 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
5981 if (size == 0 || cleared)
5982 cleared = 1;
5983 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
5984 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5985 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5986 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5987 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
5989 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5990 cleared = 1;
5993 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
5994 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
5995 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
5996 this probably loses. */
5997 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
5998 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
6000 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6001 cleared = 1;
6004 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
6005 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
6006 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
6007 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
6008 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
6009 else if (size > 0
6010 && (((int)vec_safe_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
6011 != fields_length (type))
6012 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
6013 && (!REG_P (target)
6014 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
6015 == size)))
6017 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6018 cleared = 1;
6021 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
6022 emit_clobber (target);
6024 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6025 corresponding field of TARGET. */
6026 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
6028 machine_mode mode;
6029 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6030 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
6031 tree offset;
6032 rtx to_rtx = target;
6034 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
6035 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
6036 if (field == 0)
6037 continue;
6039 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6040 continue;
6042 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (field)))
6043 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (field));
6044 else
6045 bitsize = -1;
6047 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6048 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6049 mode = VOIDmode;
6051 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
6052 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (offset)
6053 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (field)))
6055 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
6056 offset = 0;
6058 else
6059 bitpos = tree_to_shwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
6061 if (offset)
6063 machine_mode address_mode;
6064 rtx offset_rtx;
6066 offset
6067 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
6068 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
6069 target));
6071 offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
6072 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
6074 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
6075 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
6076 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
6078 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
6079 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
6082 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
6083 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
6084 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
6085 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
6086 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
6087 can understand. */
6088 if (REG_P (target)
6089 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
6090 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
6091 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6092 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
6093 && exp_size >= 0
6094 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
6096 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
6098 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
6100 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
6101 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
6102 value = fold_convert (type, value);
6105 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
6106 value
6107 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
6108 build_int_cst (type,
6109 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
6110 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
6111 mode = word_mode;
6113 #endif
6115 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
6116 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
6118 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6119 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
6122 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
6123 value, cleared,
6124 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
6126 break;
6128 case ARRAY_TYPE:
6130 tree value, index;
6131 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
6132 int need_to_clear;
6133 tree domain;
6134 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6135 int const_bounds_p;
6136 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
6137 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
6139 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
6140 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
6141 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
6142 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
6143 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)));
6145 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
6146 if (const_bounds_p)
6148 minelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
6149 maxelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
6152 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
6153 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6154 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6155 if (cleared)
6156 need_to_clear = 0;
6157 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6158 need_to_clear = 1;
6159 else
6161 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6162 tree index, value;
6163 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6164 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
6166 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
6167 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
6168 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
6169 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
6171 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
6173 if (need_to_clear)
6174 break;
6176 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6178 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6179 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6181 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index)
6182 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
6184 need_to_clear = 1;
6185 break;
6188 this_node_count = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
6189 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
6191 else
6192 this_node_count = 1;
6194 count += this_node_count;
6195 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6196 zero_count += this_node_count;
6199 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
6200 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
6201 75%. */
6202 if (! need_to_clear
6203 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
6204 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
6205 need_to_clear = 1;
6208 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
6210 if (REG_P (target))
6211 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6212 else
6213 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6214 cleared = 1;
6217 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
6218 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6219 emit_clobber (target);
6221 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6222 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
6223 elements. */
6224 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
6226 machine_mode mode;
6227 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6228 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6229 rtx xtarget = target;
6231 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6232 continue;
6234 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6235 if (mode == BLKmode)
6236 bitsize = (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype))
6237 ? tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype))
6238 : -1);
6239 else
6240 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6242 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6244 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6245 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6246 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
6247 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
6248 tree position;
6250 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
6251 if (const_bounds_p
6252 && tree_fits_shwi_p (lo_index)
6253 && tree_fits_shwi_p (hi_index)
6254 && (lo = tree_to_shwi (lo_index),
6255 hi = tree_to_shwi (hi_index),
6256 count = hi - lo + 1,
6257 (!MEM_P (target)
6258 || count <= 2
6259 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype))
6260 && (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) * count
6261 <= 40 * 8)))))
6263 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
6264 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
6266 bitpos = lo * tree_to_shwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
6268 if (MEM_P (target)
6269 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6270 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6271 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6273 target = copy_rtx (target);
6274 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6277 store_constructor_field
6278 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, cleared,
6279 get_alias_set (elttype));
6282 else
6284 rtx_code_label *loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
6285 rtx_code_label *loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
6286 tree exit_cond;
6288 expand_normal (hi_index);
6290 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
6291 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
6292 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
6293 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
6294 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false);
6296 /* Build the head of the loop. */
6297 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6298 emit_label (loop_start);
6300 /* Assign value to element index. */
6301 position =
6302 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6303 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6304 TREE_TYPE (index),
6305 index,
6306 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6308 position =
6309 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
6310 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6311 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6313 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
6314 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
6315 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6316 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6317 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6318 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
6319 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6320 else
6321 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6323 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
6324 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6325 index, hi_index);
6326 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end, -1);
6328 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
6329 the loop. */
6330 expand_assignment (index,
6331 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6332 index, integer_one_node),
6333 false);
6335 emit_jump (loop_start);
6337 /* Build the end of the loop. */
6338 emit_label (loop_end);
6341 else if ((index != 0 && ! tree_fits_shwi_p (index))
6342 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)))
6344 tree position;
6346 if (index == 0)
6347 index = ssize_int (1);
6349 if (minelt)
6350 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
6351 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6352 TREE_TYPE (index),
6353 index,
6354 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6356 position =
6357 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
6358 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6359 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6360 xtarget = offset_address (target,
6361 expand_normal (position),
6362 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6363 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6364 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6366 else
6368 if (index != 0)
6369 bitpos = ((tree_to_shwi (index) - minelt)
6370 * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6371 else
6372 bitpos = (i * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6374 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6375 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6376 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6378 target = copy_rtx (target);
6379 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6381 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
6382 cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
6385 break;
6388 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6390 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6391 constructor_elt *ce;
6392 int i;
6393 int need_to_clear;
6394 int icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6395 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6396 int elt_size = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
6397 machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6398 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6399 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6400 rtvec vector = NULL;
6401 unsigned n_elts;
6402 alias_set_type alias;
6404 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
6406 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
6407 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
6409 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6411 icode = (int) optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode);
6412 /* Don't use vec_init<mode> if some elements have VECTOR_TYPE. */
6413 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6415 tree value;
6417 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6418 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE)
6420 icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6421 break;
6424 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6426 unsigned int i;
6428 vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
6429 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
6430 RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
6434 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
6435 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6436 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6437 if (cleared)
6438 need_to_clear = 0;
6439 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6440 need_to_clear = 1;
6441 else
6443 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6444 tree value;
6446 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6448 int n_elts_here = tree_to_uhwi
6449 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6450 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
6451 TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
6453 count += n_elts_here;
6454 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6455 zero_count += n_elts_here;
6458 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
6459 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
6460 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
6463 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
6465 if (REG_P (target))
6466 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6467 else
6468 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6469 cleared = 1;
6472 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6473 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
6474 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6476 if (MEM_P (target))
6477 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
6478 else
6479 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
6481 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
6482 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
6483 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
6484 vec_safe_iterate (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, &ce);
6485 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
6487 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
6488 tree value = ce->value;
6490 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)));
6491 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6492 continue;
6494 if (ce->index)
6495 eltpos = tree_to_uhwi (ce->index);
6496 else
6497 eltpos = i;
6499 if (vector)
6501 /* vec_init<mode> should not be used if there are VECTOR_TYPE
6502 elements. */
6503 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
6504 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
6505 = expand_normal (value);
6507 else
6509 machine_mode value_mode =
6510 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
6511 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
6512 : eltmode;
6513 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
6514 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, value_mode,
6515 value, cleared, alias);
6519 if (vector)
6520 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
6521 (target,
6522 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
6523 break;
6526 default:
6527 gcc_unreachable ();
6531 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
6532 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
6533 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
6534 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
6536 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
6537 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
6538 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
6539 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
6541 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
6542 return.
6544 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
6545 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
6546 reference to the containing structure.
6548 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
6550 static rtx
6551 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6552 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
6553 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
6554 machine_mode mode, tree exp,
6555 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal)
6557 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6558 return const0_rtx;
6560 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
6561 side-effects. */
6562 if (bitsize == 0)
6563 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6565 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
6567 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
6569 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
6570 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal);
6573 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
6574 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
6575 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
6577 if (mode == VOIDmode
6578 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
6579 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
6580 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
6581 || REG_P (target)
6582 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
6583 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
6584 store it as a bit field. */
6585 || (mode != BLKmode
6586 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6587 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6588 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
6589 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
6590 || (bitsize >= 0 && mode != BLKmode
6591 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > bitsize)
6592 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
6593 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
6594 operations. */
6595 || (bitsize >= 0
6596 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
6597 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0)
6598 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
6599 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
6600 || (bitsize >= 0
6601 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
6602 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6603 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6604 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),0 ))
6605 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
6607 rtx temp;
6608 gimple nop_def;
6610 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
6611 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
6612 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
6613 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
6614 C front end. */
6615 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
6616 if (nop_def)
6618 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6619 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
6620 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
6621 && bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
6623 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
6624 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
6625 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
6626 exp = op;
6630 temp = expand_normal (exp);
6632 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
6633 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
6634 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
6635 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
6636 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
6637 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
6638 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
6639 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
6640 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) - bitsize,
6641 NULL_RTX, 1);
6643 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to MODE. */
6644 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6645 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6646 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
6648 /* If TEMP is not a PARALLEL (see below) and its mode and that of TARGET
6649 are both BLKmode, both must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned
6650 on a byte boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. Likewise for
6651 a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
6652 if (GET_CODE (temp) != PARALLEL
6653 && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
6654 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
6655 || (MEM_P (target)
6656 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
6657 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6658 && (bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)))
6660 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
6661 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
6663 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6664 emit_block_move (target, temp,
6665 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
6666 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6667 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6669 return const0_rtx;
6672 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6673 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6674 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6676 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6677 rtx temp_target;
6678 if (mode == BLKmode || mode == VOIDmode)
6679 mode = smallest_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT);
6680 temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
6681 emit_group_store (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp), size);
6682 temp = temp_target;
6684 else if (mode == BLKmode)
6686 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
6687 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
6689 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (temp));
6690 copy_blkmode_from_reg (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
6691 temp = temp_target;
6693 else
6695 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6696 rtx temp_target;
6697 mode = smallest_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT);
6698 temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
6699 temp_target
6700 = extract_bit_field (temp, size * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0, 1,
6701 temp_target, mode, mode);
6702 temp = temp_target;
6706 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
6707 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6708 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6709 mode, temp);
6711 return const0_rtx;
6713 else
6715 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
6716 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6718 if (to_rtx == target)
6719 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6721 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
6722 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
6724 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
6728 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
6729 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
6730 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
6732 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
6733 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
6734 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
6735 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
6736 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
6737 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
6739 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
6740 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
6742 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
6743 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
6745 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
6746 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
6747 this case, but the address of the object can be found.
6749 If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
6750 look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
6751 the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
6752 possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
6753 the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
6754 normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
6755 the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
6756 associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
6757 on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
6758 by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
6759 is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
6760 and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
6761 the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
6763 tree
6764 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
6765 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
6766 machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
6767 int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
6769 tree size_tree = 0;
6770 machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6771 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
6772 tree offset = size_zero_node;
6773 offset_int bit_offset = 0;
6775 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
6776 outermost expression. */
6777 *pbitsize = -1;
6778 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
6780 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6781 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
6782 if (flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
6783 && TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6784 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field)
6785 && DECL_MODE (field) != BLKmode)
6786 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
6787 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
6788 size. */
6789 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
6790 else if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6791 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6792 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
6793 blkmode_bitfield = true;
6795 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
6797 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6799 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6800 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6801 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6803 /* For vector types, with the correct size of access, use the mode of
6804 inner type. */
6805 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
6806 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6807 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6808 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6810 else
6812 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6813 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6815 if (mode == BLKmode)
6816 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6817 else
6818 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6821 if (size_tree != 0)
6823 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (size_tree))
6824 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
6825 else
6826 *pbitsize = tree_to_uhwi (size_tree);
6829 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
6830 and find the ultimate containing object. */
6831 while (1)
6833 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6835 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6836 bit_offset += wi::to_offset (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6837 break;
6839 case COMPONENT_REF:
6841 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6842 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
6844 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
6845 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
6846 type construction. */
6847 if (this_offset == 0)
6848 break;
6850 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
6851 bit_offset += wi::to_offset (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
6853 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
6855 break;
6857 case ARRAY_REF:
6858 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6860 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6861 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6862 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
6864 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
6865 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
6866 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
6867 the array element. */
6868 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6869 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6870 index, low_bound);
6872 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6873 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
6874 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
6875 unit_size));
6877 break;
6879 case REALPART_EXPR:
6880 break;
6882 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6883 bit_offset += *pbitsize;
6884 break;
6886 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6887 if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
6888 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6889 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
6890 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6891 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
6892 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6893 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6894 goto done;
6895 break;
6897 case MEM_REF:
6898 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
6899 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
6901 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6902 if (!integer_zerop (off))
6904 offset_int boff, coff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
6905 boff = wi::lshift (coff, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
6906 bit_offset += boff;
6908 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6910 goto done;
6912 default:
6913 goto done;
6916 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
6917 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
6918 *pvolatilep = 1;
6920 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6922 done:
6924 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
6925 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
6926 this conversion. */
6927 if (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST)
6929 offset_int tem = wi::sext (wi::to_offset (offset),
6930 TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
6931 tem = wi::lshift (tem, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
6932 tem += bit_offset;
6933 if (wi::fits_shwi_p (tem))
6935 *pbitpos = tem.to_shwi ();
6936 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
6940 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
6941 if (offset)
6943 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
6944 if (wi::neg_p (bit_offset))
6946 offset_int mask = wi::mask <offset_int> (LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT, false);
6947 offset_int tem = bit_offset.and_not (mask);
6948 /* TEM is the bitpos rounded to BITS_PER_UNIT towards -Inf.
6949 Subtract it to BIT_OFFSET and add it (scaled) to OFFSET. */
6950 bit_offset -= tem;
6951 tem = wi::arshift (tem, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
6952 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6953 wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, tem));
6956 *pbitpos = bit_offset.to_shwi ();
6957 *poffset = offset;
6960 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
6961 if (mode == VOIDmode
6962 && blkmode_bitfield
6963 && (*pbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6964 && (*pbitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)
6965 *pmode = BLKmode;
6966 else
6967 *pmode = mode;
6969 return exp;
6972 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
6973 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6975 tree
6976 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
6978 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
6979 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6980 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6982 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
6983 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
6984 if (aligned_size)
6986 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6987 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6988 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
6989 aligned_size = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_size);
6990 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
6991 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
6994 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
6995 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6996 else
6997 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
7000 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
7001 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
7003 tree
7004 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
7006 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
7008 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
7009 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
7010 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
7012 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
7013 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
7014 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
7015 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
7017 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
7018 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
7021 /* Returns true if REF is an array reference to an array at the end of
7022 a structure. If this is the case, the array may be allocated larger
7023 than its upper bound implies. */
7025 bool
7026 array_at_struct_end_p (tree ref)
7028 if (TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_REF
7029 && TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
7030 return false;
7032 while (handled_component_p (ref))
7034 /* If the reference chain contains a component reference to a
7035 non-union type and there follows another field the reference
7036 is not at the end of a structure. */
7037 if (TREE_CODE (ref) == COMPONENT_REF
7038 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0))) == RECORD_TYPE)
7040 tree nextf = DECL_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 1));
7041 while (nextf && TREE_CODE (nextf) != FIELD_DECL)
7042 nextf = DECL_CHAIN (nextf);
7043 if (nextf)
7044 return false;
7047 ref = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
7050 /* If the reference is based on a declared entity, the size of the array
7051 is constrained by its given domain. */
7052 if (DECL_P (ref))
7053 return false;
7055 return true;
7058 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
7059 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
7061 tree
7062 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
7064 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
7066 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
7067 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
7068 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
7069 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
7071 /* Otherwise fail. */
7072 return NULL_TREE;
7075 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
7076 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
7078 tree
7079 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
7081 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
7082 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7083 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
7085 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
7086 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
7087 value. */
7088 if (aligned_offset)
7090 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
7091 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
7092 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
7093 aligned_offset = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_offset);
7094 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
7095 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field)
7096 / BITS_PER_UNIT));
7099 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
7100 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
7101 else
7102 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
7105 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
7107 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7108 target_align (const_tree target)
7110 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
7111 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
7113 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
7115 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
7117 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
7118 return 1;
7120 case COMPONENT_REF:
7121 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
7122 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7123 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
7125 case ARRAY_REF:
7126 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
7127 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7128 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7129 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
7131 CASE_CONVERT:
7132 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7133 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
7134 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7135 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
7136 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
7138 default:
7139 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
7144 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
7145 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
7146 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
7147 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
7149 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
7152 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
7154 rtx op1, op2;
7155 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
7156 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
7157 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
7159 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
7160 if (code == SUBREG
7161 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
7162 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7164 value
7165 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7166 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7167 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7168 NULL_RTX)),
7169 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7170 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7171 code = GET_CODE (value);
7174 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
7175 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
7176 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
7177 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
7178 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
7179 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
7181 if (!subtarget)
7182 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7183 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
7184 return subtarget;
7187 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
7189 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
7190 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
7191 subtarget = 0;
7192 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
7194 code = PLUS;
7195 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
7198 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
7199 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
7200 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
7201 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
7202 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
7203 creating another one around this addition. */
7204 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
7205 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
7206 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
7207 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
7208 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
7210 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
7211 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
7212 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7213 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
7214 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
7215 0), 1), 0),
7216 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7219 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
7220 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
7221 switch (code)
7223 case MULT:
7224 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
7225 case DIV:
7226 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
7227 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7228 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7229 else
7230 return expand_divmod (0,
7231 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
7232 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
7233 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
7234 case MOD:
7235 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7236 target, 0);
7237 case UDIV:
7238 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7239 target, 1);
7240 case UMOD:
7241 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7242 target, 1);
7243 case ASHIFTRT:
7244 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7245 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7246 default:
7247 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7248 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7251 if (UNARY_P (value))
7253 if (!target)
7254 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7255 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
7256 switch (code)
7258 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7259 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7260 case TRUNCATE:
7261 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
7262 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
7263 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
7264 return target;
7266 case FIX:
7267 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
7268 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
7269 return target;
7271 case FLOAT:
7272 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
7273 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
7274 return target;
7276 default:
7277 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
7281 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
7282 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
7283 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
7284 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7285 value
7286 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7287 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7288 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7289 NULL_RTX)),
7290 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7291 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7292 #endif
7294 return value;
7297 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
7298 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
7299 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
7300 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
7302 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
7303 searches for optimization opportunities. */
7306 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
7308 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
7309 int i, nops;
7311 if (x == 0
7312 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
7313 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
7314 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
7315 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
7316 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
7317 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
7318 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7319 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
7320 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7321 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
7322 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7323 != INTEGER_CST)
7324 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
7325 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
7326 || (MEM_P (x)
7327 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
7328 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
7329 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
7330 return 1;
7332 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
7333 find the underlying pseudo. */
7334 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7336 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
7337 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7338 return 0;
7341 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
7342 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
7344 case tcc_declaration:
7345 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
7346 break;
7348 case tcc_constant:
7349 return 1;
7351 case tcc_exceptional:
7352 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
7354 while (1)
7356 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
7357 return 0;
7358 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
7359 if (!exp)
7360 return 1;
7361 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
7362 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
7365 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7367 constructor_elt *ce;
7368 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7370 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
7371 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
7372 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
7373 return 0;
7374 return 1;
7376 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7377 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
7378 else
7379 return 0;
7381 case tcc_statement:
7382 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
7383 DECL_EXPR. */
7384 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
7385 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
7386 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
7387 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
7389 case tcc_binary:
7390 case tcc_comparison:
7391 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7392 return 0;
7393 /* Fall through. */
7395 case tcc_unary:
7396 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7398 case tcc_expression:
7399 case tcc_reference:
7400 case tcc_vl_exp:
7401 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
7402 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
7403 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
7404 expression recursively. */
7406 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7408 case ADDR_EXPR:
7409 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
7410 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
7411 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7412 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
7413 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7414 return 1;
7416 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
7417 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
7418 very rare. */
7419 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7420 if (DECL_P (exp))
7422 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
7423 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
7424 return 0;
7425 else
7426 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
7428 break;
7430 case MEM_REF:
7431 if (MEM_P (x)
7432 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
7433 get_alias_set (exp)))
7434 return 0;
7435 break;
7437 case CALL_EXPR:
7438 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
7439 all of memory. */
7440 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7441 || MEM_P (x))
7442 return 0;
7443 break;
7445 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7446 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7447 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
7448 gcc_unreachable ();
7450 case SAVE_EXPR:
7451 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7453 default:
7454 break;
7457 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
7458 if (exp_rtl)
7459 break;
7461 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
7462 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
7463 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
7464 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
7465 return 0;
7467 break;
7469 case tcc_type:
7470 /* Should never get a type here. */
7471 gcc_unreachable ();
7474 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
7475 with it. */
7476 if (exp_rtl)
7478 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
7480 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
7481 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
7482 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7483 return 0;
7486 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
7487 are memory and they conflict. */
7488 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
7489 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
7490 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
7493 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
7494 return 1;
7498 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
7499 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
7501 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7502 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
7504 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ret;
7505 int trailing_zeros = tree_ctz (exp);
7506 if (trailing_zeros >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7507 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7508 ret = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << trailing_zeros;
7509 if (ret > BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
7510 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7511 return ret;
7514 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
7515 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
7516 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
7517 the structure gives the alignment. */
7519 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7520 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
7522 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
7523 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
7525 return MAX (factor, talign);
7528 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7529 /* Convert the tree comparison code TCODE to the rtl one where the
7530 signedness is UNSIGNEDP. */
7532 static enum rtx_code
7533 convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (enum tree_code tcode, int unsignedp)
7535 enum rtx_code code;
7536 switch (tcode)
7538 case EQ_EXPR:
7539 code = EQ;
7540 break;
7541 case NE_EXPR:
7542 code = NE;
7543 break;
7544 case LT_EXPR:
7545 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
7546 break;
7547 case LE_EXPR:
7548 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
7549 break;
7550 case GT_EXPR:
7551 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
7552 break;
7553 case GE_EXPR:
7554 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
7555 break;
7556 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
7557 code = UNORDERED;
7558 break;
7559 case ORDERED_EXPR:
7560 code = ORDERED;
7561 break;
7562 case UNLT_EXPR:
7563 code = UNLT;
7564 break;
7565 case UNLE_EXPR:
7566 code = UNLE;
7567 break;
7568 case UNGT_EXPR:
7569 code = UNGT;
7570 break;
7571 case UNGE_EXPR:
7572 code = UNGE;
7573 break;
7574 case UNEQ_EXPR:
7575 code = UNEQ;
7576 break;
7577 case LTGT_EXPR:
7578 code = LTGT;
7579 break;
7581 default:
7582 gcc_unreachable ();
7584 return code;
7586 #endif
7588 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
7589 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
7590 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
7591 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
7593 void
7594 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
7595 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7597 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
7598 target = 0;
7599 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
7601 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7602 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
7604 else
7606 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
7607 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
7608 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
7609 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
7610 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7611 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7616 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
7617 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
7619 static rtx
7620 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
7622 rtx mem;
7624 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
7625 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7626 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
7627 return mem;
7630 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
7631 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7633 static rtx
7634 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
7635 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
7637 rtx result, subtarget;
7638 tree inner, offset;
7639 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
7640 int volatilep, unsignedp;
7641 machine_mode mode1;
7643 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
7644 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
7645 at top level. */
7646 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
7647 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
7648 exception here is STRING_CST. */
7649 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
7651 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
7652 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7653 result = force_operand (result, target);
7654 return result;
7657 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
7658 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7660 case INDIRECT_REF:
7661 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
7662 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7664 case MEM_REF:
7666 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7667 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7668 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7669 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
7672 case CONST_DECL:
7673 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
7674 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
7675 0, modifier), 0);
7676 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7677 result = force_operand (result, target);
7678 return result;
7680 case REALPART_EXPR:
7681 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
7682 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
7683 offset = 0;
7684 bitpos = 0;
7685 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7686 break;
7688 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
7689 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
7690 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
7691 scalar type. */
7692 offset = 0;
7693 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7694 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7695 break;
7697 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
7698 /* Allow COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in initializers or coming from
7699 initializers, if e.g. rtl_for_decl_init is called on DECL_INITIAL
7700 with COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPRs in it, or ARRAY_REF on a const static
7701 array with address of COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in DECL_INITIAL;
7702 the initializers aren't gimplified. */
7703 if (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)
7704 && TREE_STATIC (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)))
7705 return expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp),
7706 target, tmode, modifier, as);
7707 /* FALLTHRU */
7708 default:
7709 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
7710 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
7711 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
7712 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
7713 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
7714 be expanded in some interesting way. */
7715 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
7716 if (DECL_P (exp)
7717 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7718 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
7720 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
7721 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7722 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
7724 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
7725 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
7726 or a tree optimizer bug. */
7728 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7729 && ! MEM_P (result)
7730 && ! targetm.calls.allocate_stack_slots_for_args ())
7732 error ("local frame unavailable (naked function?)");
7733 return result;
7735 else
7736 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
7737 result = XEXP (result, 0);
7739 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
7740 if (DECL_P (exp))
7741 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
7743 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7744 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7745 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7746 result = force_operand (result, target);
7747 return result;
7750 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
7751 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
7752 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
7753 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
7754 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
7755 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
7756 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
7757 break;
7760 /* We must have made progress. */
7761 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
7763 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7764 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
7765 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
7766 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
7767 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7769 inner = copy_node (inner);
7770 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
7771 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7772 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
7774 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
7776 if (offset)
7778 rtx tmp;
7780 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
7781 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
7782 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
7783 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7784 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7786 /* expand_expr is allowed to return an object in a mode other
7787 than TMODE. If it did, we need to convert. */
7788 if (GET_MODE (tmp) != VOIDmode && tmode != GET_MODE (tmp))
7789 tmp = convert_modes (tmode, GET_MODE (tmp),
7790 tmp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (offset)));
7791 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7792 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
7794 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7795 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
7796 else
7798 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7799 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
7800 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7804 if (bitpos)
7806 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
7807 of such an object. */
7808 gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
7810 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7811 result = plus_constant (tmode, result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7812 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7813 result = force_operand (result, target);
7816 return result;
7819 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
7820 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7822 static rtx
7823 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
7824 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7826 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
7827 machine_mode address_mode = Pmode;
7828 machine_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
7829 machine_mode rmode;
7830 rtx result;
7832 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
7833 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
7834 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7836 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7838 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7839 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
7840 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
7843 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
7844 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
7845 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
7846 if (tmode != address_mode && tmode != pointer_mode)
7847 tmode = address_mode;
7849 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7850 tmode, modifier, as);
7852 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
7853 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
7854 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
7855 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
7856 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
7857 rmode = tmode;
7858 if (rmode != tmode)
7859 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7861 return result;
7864 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
7865 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
7866 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
7867 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
7869 static rtx
7870 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
7871 bool avoid_temp_mem)
7873 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7874 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7876 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
7877 if all of the initializer is zero.
7878 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
7879 with memset. */
7880 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
7881 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7882 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
7883 && all_zeros_p (exp))
7885 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7886 return target;
7889 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7890 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7891 since that should make a CONST_INT, CONST_WIDE_INT or
7892 CONST_DOUBLE when we fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can
7893 use, it is best to store directly into the target unless the type
7894 is large enough that memcpy will be used. If we are making an
7895 initializer and all operands are constant, put it in memory as
7896 well.
7898 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7899 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7900 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7901 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
7902 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7903 && ((mode == BLKmode
7904 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7905 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7906 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type))
7907 && (! can_move_by_pieces
7908 (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)),
7909 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7910 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
7911 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7912 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7914 rtx constructor;
7916 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7917 return NULL_RTX;
7919 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
7921 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7922 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7923 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7924 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7926 return constructor;
7929 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7930 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7931 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7932 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7934 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7935 return NULL_RTX;
7937 target = assign_temp (type, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7940 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7941 return target;
7945 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
7946 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
7947 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
7949 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
7950 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7951 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
7953 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
7955 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
7956 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
7957 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
7958 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7959 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
7961 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
7962 probably will not be used.
7964 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
7965 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
7966 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
7967 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
7968 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
7969 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
7971 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
7972 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
7973 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
7974 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
7976 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
7977 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
7978 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
7980 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
7981 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
7982 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
7983 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
7984 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
7985 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
7987 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
7988 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
7989 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
7990 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
7991 recursively.
7993 If INNER_REFERENCE_P is true, we are expanding an inner reference.
7994 In this case, we don't adjust a returned MEM rtx that wouldn't be
7995 sufficiently aligned for its mode; instead, it's up to the caller
7996 to deal with it afterwards. This is used to make sure that unaligned
7997 base objects for which out-of-bounds accesses are supported, for
7998 example record types with trailing arrays, aren't realigned behind
7999 the back of the caller.
8000 The normal operating mode is to pass FALSE for this parameter. */
8003 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
8004 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
8005 bool inner_reference_p)
8007 rtx ret;
8009 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
8010 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
8011 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
8013 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
8014 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
8017 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
8018 inner_reference_p);
8019 return ret;
8022 /* Try to expand the conditional expression which is represented by
8023 TREEOP0 ? TREEOP1 : TREEOP2 using conditonal moves. If succeseds
8024 return the rtl reg which repsents the result. Otherwise return
8025 NULL_RTL. */
8027 static rtx
8028 expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (tree treeop0 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8029 tree treeop1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8030 tree treeop2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8032 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8033 rtx insn;
8034 rtx op00, op01, op1, op2;
8035 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8036 machine_mode comparison_mode;
8037 gimple srcstmt;
8038 rtx temp;
8039 tree type = TREE_TYPE (treeop1);
8040 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8041 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8042 machine_mode orig_mode = mode;
8044 /* If we cannot do a conditional move on the mode, try doing it
8045 with the promoted mode. */
8046 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8048 mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp);
8049 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8050 return NULL_RTX;
8051 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0); /* Use promoted mode for temp. */
8053 else
8054 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
8056 start_sequence ();
8057 expand_operands (treeop1, treeop2,
8058 temp, &op1, &op2, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8060 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME
8061 && (srcstmt = get_def_for_expr_class (treeop0, tcc_comparison)))
8063 tree type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
8064 enum tree_code cmpcode = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
8065 op00 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
8066 op01 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
8067 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8068 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8069 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
8071 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (treeop0)) == tcc_comparison)
8073 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
8074 enum tree_code cmpcode = TREE_CODE (treeop0);
8075 op00 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
8076 op01 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1));
8077 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8078 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8079 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
8081 else
8083 op00 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8084 op01 = const0_rtx;
8085 comparison_code = NE;
8086 comparison_mode = GET_MODE (op00);
8087 if (comparison_mode == VOIDmode)
8088 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8091 if (GET_MODE (op1) != mode)
8092 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
8094 if (GET_MODE (op2) != mode)
8095 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
8097 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8098 insn = emit_conditional_move (temp, comparison_code,
8099 op00, op01, comparison_mode,
8100 op1, op2, mode,
8101 unsignedp);
8103 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8104 and return. */
8105 if (insn)
8107 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
8108 end_sequence ();
8109 emit_insn (seq);
8110 return convert_modes (orig_mode, mode, temp, 0);
8113 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8114 branches. */
8115 end_sequence ();
8116 #endif
8117 return NULL_RTX;
8121 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
8122 enum expand_modifier modifier)
8124 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
8125 tree type;
8126 int unsignedp;
8127 machine_mode mode;
8128 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
8129 optab this_optab;
8130 rtx subtarget, original_target;
8131 int ignore;
8132 bool reduce_bit_field;
8133 location_t loc = ops->location;
8134 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
8135 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
8136 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
8137 target, \
8138 type) \
8139 : (expr))
8141 type = ops->type;
8142 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8143 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8145 treeop0 = ops->op0;
8146 treeop1 = ops->op1;
8147 treeop2 = ops->op2;
8149 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
8150 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
8151 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
8152 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
8153 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
8154 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
8156 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
8157 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
8158 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
8159 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
8161 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
8162 gcc_assert (!ignore);
8164 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
8165 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
8166 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
8167 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8168 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
8170 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8171 target = 0;
8173 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8174 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8175 original_target = target;
8177 switch (code)
8179 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8180 case PAREN_EXPR:
8181 CASE_CONVERT:
8182 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
8183 return const0_rtx;
8185 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
8187 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8189 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
8190 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
8191 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
8193 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
8194 modifier);
8196 result = copy_rtx (result);
8197 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
8198 return result;
8201 if (target == 0)
8203 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
8204 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8205 else
8206 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
8209 if (MEM_P (target))
8210 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
8211 store_expr (treeop0,
8212 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
8213 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8214 false);
8216 else
8218 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
8220 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
8221 store_field (target,
8222 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
8223 (treeop0))
8224 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
8225 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
8226 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0, 0, false);
8229 /* Return the entire union. */
8230 return target;
8233 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8235 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
8236 modifier);
8238 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
8239 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
8240 have to do the proper extension. */
8241 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
8242 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
8243 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
8245 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8248 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
8249 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
8250 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
8253 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
8254 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8256 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8257 machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
8259 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
8260 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
8262 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8263 op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
8264 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
8265 inner_mode));
8266 else
8267 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
8268 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
8271 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8272 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
8274 else if (target == 0)
8275 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
8276 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
8277 (treeop0)));
8278 else
8280 convert_move (target, op0,
8281 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8282 op0 = target;
8285 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8287 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
8289 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8290 addr_space_t as_to;
8291 addr_space_t as_from;
8293 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
8294 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
8296 as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
8297 as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
8299 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
8300 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
8301 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
8303 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
8304 to overlapping address spaces. */
8305 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
8306 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
8308 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8309 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
8310 gcc_assert (op0);
8311 return op0;
8314 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but
8315 a null pointer invokes undefined behaviour. We simply
8316 always return a null pointer here. */
8317 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
8320 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
8321 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
8322 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
8323 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
8324 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
8325 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
8326 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8327 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
8328 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
8329 treeop1));
8330 /* If sizetype precision is larger than pointer precision, truncate the
8331 offset to have matching modes. */
8332 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8333 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop1);
8335 case PLUS_EXPR:
8336 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8337 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8338 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8339 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8340 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8342 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8343 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8344 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8345 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8347 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
8348 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8349 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == VAR_DECL
8350 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
8351 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
8352 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8354 gcc_unreachable ();
8357 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8358 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8359 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8360 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8361 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8362 address.
8364 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8365 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8366 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8368 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8369 target = 0;
8370 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
8371 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8372 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
8374 rtx constant_part;
8375 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
8376 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1));
8378 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8379 EXPAND_SUM);
8380 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
8381 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8382 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8383 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8384 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0);
8385 constant_part =
8386 immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
8387 op1 = plus_constant (mode, op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8388 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8389 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8390 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
8393 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8394 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8395 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
8397 rtx constant_part;
8398 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
8399 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8401 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8402 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8403 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8404 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8406 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
8407 VOIDmode, modifier);
8408 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
8409 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
8410 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8411 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8412 goto binop2;
8414 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
8415 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8416 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8417 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8418 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1);
8419 constant_part
8420 = immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
8421 op0 = plus_constant (mode, op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8422 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8423 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8424 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8428 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
8429 as pointer subtraction. */
8430 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8431 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
8432 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
8433 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
8434 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8435 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
8437 gimple def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8438 if (def)
8440 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
8441 code = MINUS_EXPR;
8442 goto do_minus;
8446 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8447 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8448 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8449 zero-extend. */
8450 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8451 || mode != ptr_mode)
8453 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8454 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8455 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8456 return op1;
8457 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8458 return op0;
8459 goto binop2;
8462 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8463 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8464 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8466 case MINUS_EXPR:
8467 do_minus:
8468 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8469 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8470 are constant. */
8471 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8472 for the sake of an initializer. */
8473 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8474 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
8475 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
8477 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8478 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8480 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
8481 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
8482 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8483 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (mode, op0,
8484 -INTVAL (op1)));
8485 else
8486 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
8489 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8490 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8491 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8492 zero-extend. */
8493 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8494 || mode != ptr_mode)
8495 goto binop;
8497 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8498 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8500 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8501 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8503 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8504 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8507 goto binop2;
8509 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
8510 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
8511 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8512 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8513 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8514 target, unsignedp);
8515 return target;
8517 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
8518 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8519 Thus the following special case checks need only
8520 check the second operand. */
8521 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8523 tree t1 = treeop0;
8524 treeop0 = treeop1;
8525 treeop1 = t1;
8528 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
8529 unsigned operand. */
8530 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
8531 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8532 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
8534 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8535 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
8536 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8537 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8539 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8540 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8541 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8542 else
8543 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
8544 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8545 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
8546 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8547 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8549 op0 = convert_modes (innermode, mode, op0, true);
8550 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode, op1, false);
8551 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
8552 target, unsignedp));
8554 goto binop3;
8557 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
8558 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8559 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8560 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
8561 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
8563 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8564 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
8565 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
8566 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
8567 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
8569 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
8571 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8572 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8574 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8575 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8576 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
8577 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8578 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8580 widen_mult_const:
8581 op0 = convert_modes (innermode, mode, op0, zextend_p);
8583 = convert_modes (innermode, mode, op1,
8584 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8585 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
8586 target,
8587 unsignedp));
8589 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
8590 unsignedp, this_optab);
8591 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8593 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8594 != CODE_FOR_nothing
8595 && innermode == word_mode)
8597 rtx htem, hipart;
8598 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8599 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST)
8600 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
8601 expand_normal (treeop1),
8602 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8603 else
8604 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8605 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
8606 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
8607 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
8608 goto widen_mult_const;
8609 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8610 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8611 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
8612 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
8613 op0, op1, hipart,
8614 zextend_p);
8615 if (htem != hipart)
8616 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
8617 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8621 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
8622 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
8623 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8624 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8626 case FMA_EXPR:
8628 optab opt = fma_optab;
8629 gimple def0, def2;
8631 /* If there is no insn for FMA, emit it as __builtin_fma{,f,l}
8632 call. */
8633 if (optab_handler (fma_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
8635 tree fn = mathfn_built_in (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), BUILT_IN_FMA);
8636 tree call_expr;
8638 gcc_assert (fn != NULL_TREE);
8639 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
8640 return expand_builtin (call_expr, target, subtarget, mode, false);
8643 def0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop0, NEGATE_EXPR);
8644 /* The multiplication is commutative - look at its 2nd operand
8645 if the first isn't fed by a negate. */
8646 if (!def0)
8648 def0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8649 /* Swap operands if the 2nd operand is fed by a negate. */
8650 if (def0)
8652 tree tem = treeop0;
8653 treeop0 = treeop1;
8654 treeop1 = tem;
8657 def2 = get_def_for_expr (treeop2, NEGATE_EXPR);
8659 op0 = op2 = NULL;
8661 if (def0 && def2
8662 && optab_handler (fnms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8664 opt = fnms_optab;
8665 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8666 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8668 else if (def0
8669 && optab_handler (fnma_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8671 opt = fnma_optab;
8672 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8674 else if (def2
8675 && optab_handler (fms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8677 opt = fms_optab;
8678 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8681 if (op0 == NULL)
8682 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8683 if (op2 == NULL)
8684 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8685 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8687 return expand_ternary_op (TYPE_MODE (type), opt,
8688 op0, op1, op2, target, 0);
8691 case MULT_EXPR:
8692 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8693 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8694 multiplications. */
8695 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8696 goto binop;
8698 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8699 Thus the following special case checks need only
8700 check the second operand. */
8701 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8703 tree t1 = treeop0;
8704 treeop0 = treeop1;
8705 treeop1 = t1;
8708 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
8709 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
8711 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
8712 && tree_fits_shwi_p (treeop1))
8714 tree exp1 = treeop1;
8716 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8717 EXPAND_SUM);
8719 if (!REG_P (op0))
8720 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
8721 if (!REG_P (op0))
8722 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
8724 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
8725 gen_int_mode (tree_to_shwi (exp1),
8726 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
8729 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8730 target = 0;
8732 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8733 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8735 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8736 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8737 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8738 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8739 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
8740 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8741 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8742 divisions. */
8743 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8744 goto binop;
8746 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8747 target = 0;
8748 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
8749 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
8750 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
8751 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8752 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8753 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8755 case RDIV_EXPR:
8756 goto binop;
8758 case MULT_HIGHPART_EXPR:
8759 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8760 temp = expand_mult_highpart (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8761 gcc_assert (temp);
8762 return temp;
8764 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8765 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8766 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8767 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8768 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8769 target = 0;
8770 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8771 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8772 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8774 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
8775 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8776 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8777 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8779 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
8780 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8781 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
8782 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8783 else
8784 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8785 return target;
8787 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8788 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8789 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8790 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8791 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
8792 return target;
8794 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8795 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8796 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8797 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8798 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
8799 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
8800 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
8801 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
8802 op0);
8803 expand_float (target, op0,
8804 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8805 return target;
8807 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8808 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8809 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8810 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8811 target = 0;
8812 temp = expand_unop (mode,
8813 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
8814 optab_default),
8815 op0, target, 0);
8816 gcc_assert (temp);
8817 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8819 case ABS_EXPR:
8820 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8821 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8822 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8823 target = 0;
8825 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
8826 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8827 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
8829 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
8830 risk generating incorrect code below. */
8831 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8832 return op0;
8834 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
8835 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
8837 case MAX_EXPR:
8838 case MIN_EXPR:
8839 target = original_target;
8840 if (target == 0
8841 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8842 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
8843 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8844 || (REG_P (target)
8845 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8846 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8847 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8848 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8850 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
8851 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
8852 value. */
8853 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8854 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8855 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8856 if (temp != 0)
8857 return temp;
8859 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
8860 code without it. */
8862 if (! REG_P (target))
8863 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8865 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
8866 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
8868 temp = op0;
8869 op0 = op1;
8870 op1 = temp;
8873 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
8874 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
8875 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
8876 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8879 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8880 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
8882 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8883 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8884 else
8885 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8887 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
8888 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
8890 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
8891 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
8892 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
8893 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
8894 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8895 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8896 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
8898 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
8900 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
8901 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
8902 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8903 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
8904 comparison_code = LT;
8906 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8907 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
8908 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8910 rtx insn;
8912 start_sequence ();
8914 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8915 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
8916 op0, cmpop1, mode,
8917 op0, op1, mode,
8918 unsignedp);
8920 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8921 and return. */
8922 if (insn)
8924 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
8925 end_sequence ();
8926 emit_insn (seq);
8927 return target;
8930 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8931 branches. */
8932 end_sequence ();
8934 #endif
8935 if (target != op0)
8936 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
8938 temp = gen_label_rtx ();
8939 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
8940 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp,
8941 -1);
8943 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
8944 emit_label (temp);
8945 return target;
8947 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8948 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8949 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8950 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8951 target = 0;
8952 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
8953 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
8954 instead. */
8955 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8957 wide_int mask = wi::mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type),
8958 false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode));
8960 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0,
8961 immed_wide_int_const (mask, mode),
8962 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8964 else
8965 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
8966 gcc_assert (temp);
8967 return temp;
8969 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
8970 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
8971 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
8972 but that is probably not worth while. */
8974 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8975 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8976 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8977 goto binop;
8979 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8980 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8981 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
8982 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type))
8983 == TYPE_PRECISION (type)));
8984 /* fall through */
8986 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8987 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8988 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8989 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8990 shifts. */
8991 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8992 goto binop;
8994 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
8995 subtarget = 0;
8996 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8997 target = 0;
8998 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8999 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9000 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
9001 unsignedp);
9002 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
9003 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9004 return temp;
9006 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
9007 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
9008 case LT_EXPR:
9009 case LE_EXPR:
9010 case GT_EXPR:
9011 case GE_EXPR:
9012 case EQ_EXPR:
9013 case NE_EXPR:
9014 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
9015 case ORDERED_EXPR:
9016 case UNLT_EXPR:
9017 case UNLE_EXPR:
9018 case UNGT_EXPR:
9019 case UNGE_EXPR:
9020 case UNEQ_EXPR:
9021 case LTGT_EXPR:
9022 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
9023 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
9024 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9025 if (temp)
9026 return temp;
9028 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
9029 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
9031 if ((target == 0
9032 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9033 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
9034 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
9035 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
9036 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
9037 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
9038 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
9039 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9041 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
9043 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9044 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
9046 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
9047 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
9048 else
9049 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
9051 emit_label (op1);
9052 return target;
9054 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
9055 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
9056 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9057 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
9059 if (!target)
9060 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
9061 else
9062 /* If target overlaps with op1, then either we need to force
9063 op1 into a pseudo (if target also overlaps with op0),
9064 or write the complex parts in reverse order. */
9065 switch (GET_CODE (target))
9067 case CONCAT:
9068 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 0), op1))
9070 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 1), op0))
9072 complex_expr_force_op1:
9073 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)));
9074 emit_move_insn (temp, op1);
9075 op1 = temp;
9076 break;
9078 complex_expr_swap_order:
9079 /* Move the imaginary (op1) and real (op0) parts to their
9080 location. */
9081 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
9082 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
9084 return target;
9086 break;
9087 case MEM:
9088 temp = adjust_address_nv (target,
9089 GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)), 0);
9090 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op1))
9092 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target));
9093 temp = adjust_address_nv (target, imode,
9094 GET_MODE_SIZE (imode));
9095 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op0))
9096 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
9097 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
9099 break;
9100 default:
9101 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op1))
9103 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op0))
9104 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
9105 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
9107 break;
9110 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
9111 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
9112 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
9114 return target;
9116 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
9118 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9119 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9121 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9122 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
9123 target, unsignedp);
9124 return target;
9127 case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
9128 case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
9129 case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
9131 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9132 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9133 machine_mode vec_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9135 if (optab_handler (this_optab, vec_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
9137 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9138 enum insn_code icode = optab_handler (this_optab, vec_mode);
9140 create_output_operand (&ops[0], target, mode);
9141 create_input_operand (&ops[1], op0, vec_mode);
9142 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 2, ops))
9144 target = ops[0].value;
9145 if (GET_MODE (target) != mode)
9146 return gen_lowpart (tmode, target);
9147 return target;
9150 /* Fall back to optab with vector result, and then extract scalar. */
9151 this_optab = scalar_reduc_to_vector (this_optab, type);
9152 temp = expand_unop (vec_mode, this_optab, op0, NULL_RTX, unsignedp);
9153 gcc_assert (temp);
9154 /* The tree code produces a scalar result, but (somewhat by convention)
9155 the optab produces a vector with the result in element 0 if
9156 little-endian, or element N-1 if big-endian. So pull the scalar
9157 result out of that element. */
9158 int index = BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? GET_MODE_NUNITS (vec_mode) - 1 : 0;
9159 int bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE_INNER (vec_mode));
9160 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, bitsize, bitsize * index, unsignedp,
9161 target, mode, mode);
9162 gcc_assert (temp);
9163 return temp;
9166 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
9167 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
9169 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9170 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
9171 target, unsignedp);
9172 gcc_assert (temp);
9173 return temp;
9176 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
9177 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
9179 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9180 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
9181 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
9182 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
9183 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9185 gcc_assert (temp);
9186 return temp;
9189 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
9190 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
9191 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_EVEN_EXPR:
9192 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_ODD_EXPR:
9193 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
9194 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
9195 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9196 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
9197 target, unsignedp);
9198 gcc_assert (target);
9199 return target;
9201 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
9202 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
9203 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9204 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9205 goto binop;
9207 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
9208 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9209 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
9211 /* Careful here: if the target doesn't support integral vector modes,
9212 a constant selection vector could wind up smooshed into a normal
9213 integral constant. */
9214 if (CONSTANT_P (op2) && GET_CODE (op2) != CONST_VECTOR)
9216 tree sel_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop2);
9217 machine_mode vmode
9218 = mode_for_vector (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (sel_type)),
9219 TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (sel_type));
9220 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (vmode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
9221 op2 = simplify_subreg (vmode, op2, TYPE_MODE (sel_type), 0);
9222 gcc_assert (op2 && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_VECTOR);
9224 else
9225 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op2)) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
9227 temp = expand_vec_perm (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
9228 gcc_assert (temp);
9229 return temp;
9231 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
9233 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9234 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9235 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9236 rtx op2;
9238 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9239 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9240 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
9241 target, unsignedp);
9242 return target;
9245 case SAD_EXPR:
9247 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9248 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9249 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9250 rtx op2;
9252 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9253 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9254 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
9255 target, unsignedp);
9256 return target;
9259 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
9261 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9262 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9263 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9264 rtx op2;
9266 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9267 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9268 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9269 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
9270 target, unsignedp);
9271 gcc_assert (temp);
9272 return temp;
9275 case COND_EXPR:
9276 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
9277 conditional jump and is handled in
9278 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
9279 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
9281 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
9282 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
9283 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
9284 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
9286 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
9287 && !ignore
9288 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
9289 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
9291 temp = expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
9292 if (temp)
9293 return temp;
9295 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
9296 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
9297 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
9298 temporary. */
9300 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9301 && original_target
9302 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
9303 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
9304 && !MEM_P (original_target))
9305 temp = original_target;
9306 else
9307 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
9309 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9310 NO_DEFER_POP;
9311 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
9312 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9313 jumpifnot (treeop0, op0, -1);
9314 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
9315 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9316 false);
9318 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
9319 emit_barrier ();
9320 emit_label (op0);
9321 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
9322 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9323 false);
9325 emit_label (op1);
9326 OK_DEFER_POP;
9327 return temp;
9329 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
9330 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
9331 return target;
9333 default:
9334 gcc_unreachable ();
9337 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
9338 binop:
9339 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9340 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9341 binop2:
9342 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9343 binop3:
9344 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9345 target = 0;
9346 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9347 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9348 gcc_assert (temp);
9349 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
9350 operands being properly truncated. */
9351 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
9352 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
9353 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
9354 return temp;
9355 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9357 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
9360 /* Return TRUE if expression STMT is suitable for replacement.
9361 Never consider memory loads as replaceable, because those don't ever lead
9362 into constant expressions. */
9364 static bool
9365 stmt_is_replaceable_p (gimple stmt)
9367 if (ssa_is_replaceable_p (stmt))
9369 /* Don't move around loads. */
9370 if (!gimple_assign_single_p (stmt)
9371 || is_gimple_val (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
9372 return true;
9374 return false;
9378 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
9379 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
9380 bool inner_reference_p)
9382 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
9383 tree type;
9384 int unsignedp;
9385 machine_mode mode;
9386 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
9387 rtx subtarget, original_target;
9388 int ignore;
9389 tree context;
9390 bool reduce_bit_field;
9391 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
9392 struct separate_ops ops;
9393 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
9394 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
9395 gimple g;
9397 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9398 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9399 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9401 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
9402 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
9403 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
9405 default:
9406 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
9407 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9408 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9409 case 0: break;
9411 ops.code = code;
9412 ops.type = type;
9413 ops.op0 = treeop0;
9414 ops.op1 = treeop1;
9415 ops.op2 = treeop2;
9416 ops.location = loc;
9418 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9419 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9420 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9421 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9423 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9424 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9425 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9426 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
9427 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9428 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
9430 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
9431 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
9432 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
9433 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
9434 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
9436 if (ignore)
9438 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
9439 return const0_rtx;
9441 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
9442 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
9443 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
9444 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
9445 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
9446 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9448 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9449 if (MEM_P (temp))
9450 copy_to_reg (temp);
9451 return const0_rtx;
9454 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
9455 || code == BIT_FIELD_REF
9456 || code == COMPONENT_REF
9457 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
9458 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
9459 modifier);
9461 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
9462 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
9463 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
9465 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9466 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9467 return const0_rtx;
9470 target = 0;
9473 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9474 target = 0;
9476 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9477 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9478 original_target = target;
9480 switch (code)
9482 case LABEL_DECL:
9484 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
9486 temp = label_rtx (exp);
9487 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
9489 if (function != current_function_decl
9490 && function != 0)
9491 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
9493 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
9494 return temp;
9497 case SSA_NAME:
9498 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
9499 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
9500 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
9501 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
9502 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
9504 tree var = SSA_NAME_VAR (exp);
9505 if (var && DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
9506 return DECL_RTL (var);
9507 return gen_raw_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9508 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
9511 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
9512 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
9513 if (g == NULL
9514 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9515 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
9516 && (optimize || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
9517 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
9518 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
9519 if (g)
9521 rtx r;
9522 ops.code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (g);
9523 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (ops.code))
9525 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
9526 ops.op2 = gimple_assign_rhs3 (g);
9527 /* Fallthru */
9528 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
9529 ops.op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (g);
9531 /* Try to expand conditonal compare. */
9532 if (targetm.gen_ccmp_first)
9534 gcc_checking_assert (targetm.gen_ccmp_next != NULL);
9535 r = expand_ccmp_expr (g);
9536 if (r)
9537 break;
9539 /* Fallthru */
9540 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
9541 ops.op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (g);
9542 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (g));
9543 ops.location = gimple_location (g);
9544 r = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
9545 break;
9546 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
9548 location_t saved_loc = curr_insn_location ();
9549 set_curr_insn_location (gimple_location (g));
9550 r = expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs1 (g), target,
9551 tmode, modifier, NULL, inner_reference_p);
9552 set_curr_insn_location (saved_loc);
9553 break;
9555 default:
9556 gcc_unreachable ();
9558 if (REG_P (r) && !REG_EXPR (r))
9559 set_reg_attrs_for_decl_rtl (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), r);
9560 return r;
9563 ssa_name = exp;
9564 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
9565 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
9566 goto expand_decl_rtl;
9568 case PARM_DECL:
9569 case VAR_DECL:
9570 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
9571 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
9572 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
9573 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9574 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
9575 layout_decl (exp, 0);
9577 /* ... fall through ... */
9579 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9580 case RESULT_DECL:
9581 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
9582 expand_decl_rtl:
9583 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
9584 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
9585 /* Record writes to register variables. */
9586 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
9587 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
9588 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
9589 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
9590 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
9592 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
9593 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
9594 definition. */
9595 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
9597 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
9598 temp = 0;
9600 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
9601 been lowered by this point. */
9602 context = decl_function_context (exp);
9603 gcc_assert (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (context)
9604 || context == current_function_decl
9605 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
9606 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
9607 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
9608 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
9610 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
9611 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
9612 ??? We aren't parsing while expanding anymore. */
9614 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
9615 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
9617 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
9618 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
9620 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9622 if (alt_rtl)
9623 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
9624 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
9625 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9626 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9627 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
9628 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
9629 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
9630 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
9631 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
9634 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
9635 if the address is a register. */
9636 if (temp != 0)
9638 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
9639 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
9641 return temp;
9644 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
9645 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
9646 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
9647 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
9648 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
9649 was already extended. */
9650 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
9651 && DECL_MODE (exp) != BLKmode
9652 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
9654 machine_mode pmode;
9656 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
9657 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
9658 if (code == SSA_NAME
9659 && (g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
9660 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL
9661 && !gimple_call_internal_p (g))
9662 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
9663 gimple_call_fntype (g),
9665 else
9666 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
9667 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
9669 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
9670 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
9671 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
9672 return temp;
9675 return decl_rtl;
9677 case INTEGER_CST:
9678 /* Given that TYPE_PRECISION (type) is not always equal to
9679 GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type)), we need to extend from
9680 the former to the latter according to the signedness of the
9681 type. */
9682 temp = immed_wide_int_const (wide_int::from
9683 (exp,
9684 GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type)),
9685 TYPE_SIGN (type)),
9686 TYPE_MODE (type));
9687 return temp;
9689 case VECTOR_CST:
9691 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
9692 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
9693 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
9694 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FRACT
9695 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UFRACT
9696 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_ACCUM
9697 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UACCUM)
9698 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
9699 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
9701 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
9702 if (type_for_mode)
9703 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
9705 if (!tmp)
9707 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *v;
9708 unsigned i;
9709 vec_alloc (v, VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp));
9710 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
9711 CONSTRUCTOR_APPEND_ELT (v, NULL_TREE, VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i));
9712 tmp = build_constructor (type, v);
9714 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
9715 tmode, modifier);
9718 case CONST_DECL:
9719 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
9721 case REAL_CST:
9722 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
9723 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
9725 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
9726 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
9727 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
9728 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
9729 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
9731 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
9732 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
9733 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9735 case FIXED_CST:
9736 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
9737 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9739 case COMPLEX_CST:
9740 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
9741 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
9743 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9744 rtx rtarg, itarg;
9746 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
9747 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
9749 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
9750 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9751 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9753 if (op0 != rtarg)
9754 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
9755 if (op1 != itarg)
9756 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
9758 return original_target;
9761 /* ... fall through ... */
9763 case STRING_CST:
9764 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
9766 /* temp contains a constant address.
9767 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
9768 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
9769 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9770 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9771 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9772 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
9773 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
9774 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
9775 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
9776 return temp;
9778 case SAVE_EXPR:
9780 tree val = treeop0;
9781 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
9782 inner_reference_p);
9784 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
9786 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
9787 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
9788 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
9789 with non-BLKmode values. */
9790 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
9792 val = build_decl (curr_insn_location (),
9793 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
9794 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
9795 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
9796 treeop0 = val;
9797 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
9798 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
9800 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
9801 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
9802 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
9805 return ret;
9809 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9810 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
9811 subexpressions. */
9812 if (ignore)
9814 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9815 tree value;
9817 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
9818 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9820 return const0_rtx;
9823 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
9825 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
9827 addr_space_t as
9828 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9829 enum insn_code icode;
9830 unsigned int align;
9832 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (exp, as, true);
9833 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9834 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9835 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9836 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9837 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9838 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9839 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9840 && mode != BLKmode
9841 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9842 /* If the target does not have special handling for unaligned
9843 loads of mode then it can use regular moves for them. */
9844 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9845 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9847 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9849 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9850 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9851 nor can the generator. */
9852 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9853 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9854 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9855 temp = ops[0].value;
9857 return temp;
9860 case MEM_REF:
9862 addr_space_t as
9863 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9864 machine_mode address_mode;
9865 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9866 gimple def_stmt;
9867 enum insn_code icode;
9868 unsigned align;
9869 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
9870 might end up in a register. */
9871 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
9873 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).to_short_addr ();
9874 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
9875 if (offset == 0
9876 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type))
9877 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base))
9878 == tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type))))
9879 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type, base),
9880 target, tmode, modifier);
9881 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
9883 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
9884 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)));
9885 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false);
9886 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
9887 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (type));
9888 return temp;
9890 exp = build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, type, base, TYPE_SIZE (type),
9891 bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT));
9892 return expand_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
9894 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
9895 base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9896 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
9898 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
9899 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
9900 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
9901 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
9903 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9904 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
9905 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9906 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9908 rtx off = immed_wide_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
9909 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
9910 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9912 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9913 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9914 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9915 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
9916 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
9917 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9918 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9919 && !inner_reference_p
9920 && mode != BLKmode
9921 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
9923 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9924 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
9926 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9928 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9929 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9930 nor can the generator. */
9931 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9932 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9933 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9934 temp = ops[0].value;
9936 else if (SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align))
9937 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
9938 0, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9939 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9940 ? NULL_RTX : target),
9941 mode, mode);
9943 return temp;
9946 case ARRAY_REF:
9949 tree array = treeop0;
9950 tree index = treeop1;
9951 tree init;
9953 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
9954 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
9955 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
9956 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
9958 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9959 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9960 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
9962 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
9964 if (t)
9965 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
9968 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
9969 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
9970 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
9971 that was declared const. */
9973 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9974 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9975 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9976 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
9977 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9978 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9980 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9981 tree field, value;
9983 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
9984 field, value)
9985 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9987 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9988 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
9989 break;
9993 else if (optimize >= 1
9994 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9995 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9996 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9997 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9998 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
9999 && (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL
10000 || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10001 && (init = ctor_for_folding (array)) != error_mark_node)
10003 if (init == NULL_TREE)
10005 tree value = build_zero_cst (type);
10006 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10008 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this optimization is only
10009 useful if this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR into
10010 memory. If it does, it is more efficient to just
10011 load the data from the array directly. */
10012 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
10013 modifier, true);
10014 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
10015 value = NULL_TREE;
10018 if (value)
10019 return expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
10021 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10023 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10024 tree field, value;
10026 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
10027 field, value)
10028 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
10030 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
10031 break;
10033 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10035 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
10036 optimization is only useful if
10037 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
10038 into memory. If it does, it is more
10039 efficient to just load the data from
10040 the array directly. */
10041 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
10042 modifier, true);
10043 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
10044 break;
10047 return
10048 expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
10051 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
10053 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
10054 tree index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, treeop1);
10056 /* Optimize the special case of a zero lower bound.
10058 We convert the lower bound to sizetype to avoid problems
10059 with constant folding. E.g. suppose the lower bound is
10060 1 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion
10061 (ARRAY + (INDEX - (unsigned char)1))
10062 becomes
10063 (ARRAY + (-(unsigned char)1) + INDEX)
10064 which becomes
10065 (ARRAY + 255 + INDEX). Oops! */
10066 if (!integer_zerop (low_bound))
10067 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
10068 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
10069 low_bound));
10071 if (compare_tree_int (index1, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)) < 0)
10073 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
10074 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
10076 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10077 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
10078 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
10079 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
10080 mode);
10085 goto normal_inner_ref;
10087 case COMPONENT_REF:
10088 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
10089 appropriate field if it is present. */
10090 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
10092 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
10093 tree field, value;
10095 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
10096 idx, field, value)
10097 if (field == treeop1
10098 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
10099 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
10100 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
10101 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
10102 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
10103 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
10104 we can't do this optimization. */
10105 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
10106 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
10107 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (DECL_MODE (field))
10108 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
10110 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
10111 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10112 target = 0;
10113 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
10114 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
10116 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
10117 machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
10119 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
10121 op1 = gen_int_mode (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1,
10122 imode);
10123 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
10125 else
10127 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (imode) - bitsize;
10129 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
10130 target, 0);
10131 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
10132 target, 0);
10136 return op0;
10139 goto normal_inner_ref;
10141 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
10142 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
10143 normal_inner_ref:
10145 machine_mode mode1, mode2;
10146 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10147 tree offset;
10148 int volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
10149 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
10150 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
10151 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
10152 bool clear_mem_expr = false;
10154 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
10155 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
10156 infinitely recurse. */
10157 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
10159 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
10160 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
10161 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
10162 orig_op0 = op0
10163 = expand_expr_real (tem,
10164 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10165 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
10166 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10167 != INTEGER_CST)
10168 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10169 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10170 VOIDmode,
10171 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier,
10172 NULL, true);
10174 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
10175 field's mode, not the computed mode.
10176 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
10177 use BLKmode for it instead. */
10178 if (MEM_P (op0))
10180 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
10181 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
10182 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
10183 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
10186 mode2
10187 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
10189 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
10190 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
10191 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
10192 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
10193 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
10194 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
10195 to a larger size. */
10196 must_force_mem = (offset
10197 || mode1 == BLKmode
10198 || bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2));
10200 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
10201 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
10203 if (bitpos == 0
10204 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10205 return op0;
10206 if (bitpos == 0
10207 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10208 && bitsize)
10210 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10211 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
10213 else if (bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10214 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1)))
10215 && bitpos
10216 && bitsize)
10218 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10219 bitpos = 0;
10220 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
10222 else
10223 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
10224 must_force_mem = 1;
10227 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
10228 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
10229 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
10230 && mode2 != BLKmode
10231 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
10232 && !must_force_mem)
10233 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
10235 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
10236 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
10237 is a legitimate constant. */
10238 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
10239 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
10241 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
10242 and need be, put it there. */
10243 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
10245 memloc = assign_temp (TREE_TYPE (tem), 1, 1);
10246 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
10247 op0 = memloc;
10248 clear_mem_expr = true;
10251 if (offset)
10253 machine_mode address_mode;
10254 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
10255 EXPAND_SUM);
10257 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
10259 address_mode = get_address_mode (op0);
10260 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
10261 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
10263 /* See the comment in expand_assignment for the rationale. */
10264 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
10265 && bitpos != 0
10266 && bitsize > 0
10267 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
10268 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
10269 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
10271 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10272 bitpos = 0;
10275 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
10276 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
10279 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
10280 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10281 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
10282 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
10283 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
10285 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
10286 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
10288 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10289 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10291 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
10294 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
10295 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
10296 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
10297 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
10298 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
10299 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
10300 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
10301 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
10302 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
10303 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
10304 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
10305 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10306 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10307 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
10308 /* If the bitfield is volatile and the bitsize
10309 is narrower than the access size of the bitfield,
10310 we need to extract bitfields from the access. */
10311 || (volatilep && TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF
10312 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
10313 && mode1 != BLKmode
10314 && bitsize < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT)
10315 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
10316 fetch it as a bit field. */
10317 || (mode1 != BLKmode
10318 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10319 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
10320 || (MEM_P (op0)
10321 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
10322 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
10323 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10324 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10325 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10326 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10327 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
10328 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
10329 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
10330 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
10331 we must use bitfield operations. */
10332 || (bitsize >= 0
10333 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
10334 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
10335 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
10336 bitsize)))
10338 machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
10340 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
10341 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
10342 && MEM_P (target)
10343 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
10344 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
10346 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
10348 if (target == 0)
10349 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
10351 /* ??? Unlike the similar test a few lines below, this one is
10352 very likely obsolete. */
10353 if (bitsize == 0)
10354 return target;
10356 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
10357 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
10358 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
10359 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
10360 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
10362 emit_block_move (target,
10363 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
10364 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10365 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
10366 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10367 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10368 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10370 return target;
10373 /* If we have nothing to extract, the result will be 0 for targets
10374 with SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED == 0 and garbage otherwise. Always
10375 return 0 for the sake of consistency, as reading a zero-sized
10376 bitfield is valid in Ada and the value is fully specified. */
10377 if (bitsize == 0)
10378 return const0_rtx;
10380 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
10382 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10383 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10385 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
10386 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10387 ? NULL_RTX : target),
10388 ext_mode, ext_mode);
10390 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
10391 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
10392 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
10393 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10394 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
10395 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10396 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10397 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
10398 - bitsize, op0, 1);
10400 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
10401 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
10402 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). */
10403 if (mode == BLKmode)
10405 rtx new_rtx
10406 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode,
10407 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode),
10408 type);
10409 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
10410 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
10411 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
10414 return op0;
10417 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
10418 now as well. */
10419 if (mode == BLKmode)
10420 mode1 = BLKmode;
10422 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10423 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10424 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10425 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10426 else
10427 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10429 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10430 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10432 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
10434 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10435 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10437 /* If op0 is a temporary because the original expressions was forced
10438 to memory, clear MEM_EXPR so that the original expression cannot
10439 be marked as addressable through MEM_EXPR of the temporary. */
10440 if (clear_mem_expr)
10441 set_mem_expr (op0, NULL_TREE);
10443 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10444 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
10445 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10446 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10447 return op0;
10449 if (target == 0)
10450 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
10452 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
10453 return target;
10456 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
10457 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
10459 case CALL_EXPR:
10460 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
10461 inlining. */
10462 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
10463 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
10465 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
10467 if (fndecl
10468 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
10469 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10470 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
10471 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10472 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10473 if (fndecl
10474 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
10475 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10476 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
10477 0, "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
10478 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10479 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10481 /* Check for a built-in function. */
10482 if (fndecl && DECL_BUILT_IN (fndecl))
10484 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
10485 if (CALL_WITH_BOUNDS_P (exp))
10486 return expand_builtin_with_bounds (exp, target, subtarget,
10487 tmode, ignore);
10488 else
10489 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
10492 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
10494 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10495 op0 = NULL_RTX;
10497 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
10498 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
10499 if (mode == BLKmode
10500 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST
10501 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
10502 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
10504 machine_mode mode1;
10505 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10506 tree offset;
10507 int unsignedp;
10508 int volatilep = 0;
10509 tree tem
10510 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos,
10511 &offset, &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
10512 true);
10513 rtx orig_op0;
10515 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
10516 if (!offset
10517 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
10518 && bitsize >= 0
10519 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (type), bitsize) == 0)
10521 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
10522 orig_op0
10523 = expand_expr_real (tem,
10524 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10525 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10526 != INTEGER_CST)
10527 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10528 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10529 VOIDmode,
10530 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier,
10531 NULL, true);
10533 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
10535 op0 = orig_op0;
10537 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10538 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10539 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
10540 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10541 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10542 else
10543 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10545 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10546 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10548 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
10549 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10550 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10552 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10557 if (!op0)
10558 op0 = expand_expr_real (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier,
10559 NULL, inner_reference_p);
10561 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
10562 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
10564 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
10565 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
10566 else if (mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
10567 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)
10568 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
10569 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
10571 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
10572 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10573 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
10574 if (temp)
10575 op0 = temp;
10576 else
10578 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
10579 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10580 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
10583 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
10584 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10585 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10586 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10587 /* If the output type is a bit-field type, do an extraction. */
10588 else if (reduce_bit_field)
10589 return extract_bit_field (op0, TYPE_PRECISION (type), 0,
10590 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type), NULL_RTX,
10591 mode, mode);
10592 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
10593 different mode. */
10594 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
10596 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
10597 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
10598 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
10599 constants to change mode. */
10600 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10602 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10604 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
10605 target
10606 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
10607 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
10608 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), inner_type);
10610 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
10611 op0 = target;
10614 /* If OP0 is (now) a MEM, we need to deal with alignment issues. If the
10615 output type is such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate
10616 that it is. Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for
10617 non-BLKmode results. */
10618 if (MEM_P (op0))
10620 enum insn_code icode;
10622 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
10624 /* ??? Copying the MEM without substantially changing it might
10625 run afoul of the code handling volatile memory references in
10626 store_expr, which assumes that TARGET is returned unmodified
10627 if it has been used. */
10628 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10629 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
10631 else if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
10632 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
10633 && !inner_reference_p
10634 && mode != BLKmode
10635 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10637 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
10638 loads of mode then use them. */
10639 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
10640 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10642 rtx reg, insn;
10644 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10645 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
10646 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
10647 fail. */
10648 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10650 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
10651 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
10652 emit_insn (insn);
10653 return reg;
10655 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT)
10657 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10658 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
10659 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
10660 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
10661 rtx new_rtx
10662 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, type);
10663 rtx new_with_op0_mode
10664 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
10666 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10668 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
10669 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
10670 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
10671 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10672 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10673 else
10674 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
10676 op0 = new_rtx;
10680 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10683 return op0;
10685 case MODIFY_EXPR:
10687 tree lhs = treeop0;
10688 tree rhs = treeop1;
10689 gcc_assert (ignore);
10691 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
10692 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
10693 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
10694 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
10696 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
10697 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
10698 support it. */
10699 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
10700 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
10701 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
10702 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
10703 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
10704 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
10705 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
10707 rtx_code_label *label = gen_label_rtx ();
10708 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
10709 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
10710 value ? label : 0,
10711 value ? 0 : label, -1);
10712 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
10713 false);
10714 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10715 emit_label (label);
10716 return const0_rtx;
10719 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, false);
10720 return const0_rtx;
10723 case ADDR_EXPR:
10724 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
10726 case REALPART_EXPR:
10727 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10728 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
10730 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
10731 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10732 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
10734 case RETURN_EXPR:
10735 case LABEL_EXPR:
10736 case GOTO_EXPR:
10737 case SWITCH_EXPR:
10738 case ASM_EXPR:
10739 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
10740 gcc_unreachable ();
10742 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
10743 case CATCH_EXPR:
10744 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
10745 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
10746 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
10747 gcc_unreachable ();
10749 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
10750 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
10751 case TARGET_EXPR:
10752 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
10753 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
10754 case BIND_EXPR:
10755 case INIT_EXPR:
10756 case CONJ_EXPR:
10757 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
10758 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
10759 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
10760 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
10761 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
10762 case LOOP_EXPR:
10763 case EXIT_EXPR:
10764 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
10765 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
10766 gcc_unreachable ();
10768 case FDESC_EXPR:
10769 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
10770 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
10771 gcc_unreachable ();
10773 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
10774 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
10775 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
10776 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
10777 modifier, alt_rtl, inner_reference_p);
10779 default:
10780 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
10784 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
10785 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
10786 static rtx
10787 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
10789 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
10790 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
10791 target = 0;
10792 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
10793 if (CONST_INT_P (exp))
10795 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
10796 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
10797 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10799 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10801 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (exp);
10802 rtx mask = immed_wide_int_const
10803 (wi::mask (prec, false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
10804 return expand_and (mode, exp, mask, target);
10806 else
10808 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec;
10809 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10810 exp, count, target, 0);
10811 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10812 exp, count, target, 0);
10816 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
10817 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
10818 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10820 static int
10821 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
10823 /* Strip off any conversions. */
10824 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10825 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10827 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
10828 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10829 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
10830 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1))
10831 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
10832 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
10833 || exact_log2 (tree_to_uhwi (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1)) + 1) < 0)
10834 return 0;
10836 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
10837 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
10838 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10839 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10840 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10842 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
10843 return 0;
10845 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10846 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10847 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10849 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
10850 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
10853 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
10854 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
10855 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
10856 offset will be `sizetype'. */
10858 tree
10859 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
10861 tree array, offset, lower_bound;
10862 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
10864 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
10866 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
10868 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
10869 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10871 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
10873 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10874 offset = size_zero_node;
10876 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
10878 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10879 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10880 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10881 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10882 return 0;
10884 /* Check if the array has a nonzero lower bound. */
10885 lower_bound = array_ref_low_bound (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0));
10886 if (!integer_zerop (lower_bound))
10888 /* If the offset and base aren't both constants, return 0. */
10889 if (TREE_CODE (lower_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
10890 return 0;
10891 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != INTEGER_CST)
10892 return 0;
10893 /* Adjust offset by the lower bound. */
10894 offset = size_diffop (fold_convert (sizetype, offset),
10895 fold_convert (sizetype, lower_bound));
10898 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == MEM_REF)
10900 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10901 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10902 if (TREE_CODE (array) != ADDR_EXPR)
10903 return 0;
10904 array = TREE_OPERAND (array, 0);
10905 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10906 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10907 return 0;
10909 else
10910 return 0;
10912 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
10914 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10915 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
10917 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10918 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10920 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
10921 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
10922 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10924 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
10925 offset = arg1;
10927 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
10928 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
10929 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10931 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
10932 offset = arg0;
10934 else
10935 return 0;
10937 else
10938 return 0;
10940 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
10942 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10943 return array;
10945 else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL
10946 || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10948 int length;
10949 tree init = ctor_for_folding (array);
10951 /* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
10952 if (init == error_mark_node
10953 || !init
10954 || TREE_CODE (init) != STRING_CST)
10955 return 0;
10957 /* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
10958 if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
10959 || TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
10960 || (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)) <= 0
10961 || compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
10962 return 0;
10964 /* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
10965 and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
10966 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10967 if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
10968 && (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (offset)
10969 || compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
10970 return 0;
10972 *ptr_offset = offset;
10973 return init;
10976 return 0;
10979 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
10980 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
10981 OPS reflects a comparison.
10983 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
10985 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
10986 available on this machine.
10988 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
10989 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
10990 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
10991 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
10992 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
10993 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
10994 set/jump/set sequence. */
10996 static rtx
10997 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode mode)
10999 enum rtx_code code;
11000 tree arg0, arg1, type;
11001 tree tem;
11002 machine_mode operand_mode;
11003 int unsignedp;
11004 rtx op0, op1;
11005 rtx subtarget = target;
11006 location_t loc = ops->location;
11008 arg0 = ops->op0;
11009 arg1 = ops->op1;
11011 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
11012 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
11013 return const0_rtx;
11015 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
11016 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
11017 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
11019 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
11020 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
11021 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
11022 return 0;
11024 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
11025 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
11026 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
11027 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
11028 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)) == POINTER_TYPE
11029 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)))
11030 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
11031 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)) == POINTER_TYPE
11032 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)))
11033 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
11034 return 0;
11035 #endif
11037 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
11038 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
11040 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
11041 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
11042 expander for this. */
11043 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11045 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
11046 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
11047 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
11048 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true, if_false, target);
11051 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
11052 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
11053 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
11054 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
11055 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
11056 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
11058 switch (ops->code)
11060 case EQ_EXPR:
11061 code = EQ;
11062 break;
11063 case NE_EXPR:
11064 code = NE;
11065 break;
11066 case LT_EXPR:
11067 if (integer_onep (arg1))
11068 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
11069 else
11070 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
11071 break;
11072 case LE_EXPR:
11073 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
11074 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
11075 else
11076 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
11077 break;
11078 case GT_EXPR:
11079 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
11080 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
11081 else
11082 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
11083 break;
11084 case GE_EXPR:
11085 if (integer_onep (arg1))
11086 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
11087 else
11088 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
11089 break;
11091 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
11092 code = UNORDERED;
11093 break;
11094 case ORDERED_EXPR:
11095 code = ORDERED;
11096 break;
11097 case UNLT_EXPR:
11098 code = UNLT;
11099 break;
11100 case UNLE_EXPR:
11101 code = UNLE;
11102 break;
11103 case UNGT_EXPR:
11104 code = UNGT;
11105 break;
11106 case UNGE_EXPR:
11107 code = UNGE;
11108 break;
11109 case UNEQ_EXPR:
11110 code = UNEQ;
11111 break;
11112 case LTGT_EXPR:
11113 code = LTGT;
11114 break;
11116 default:
11117 gcc_unreachable ();
11120 /* Put a constant second. */
11121 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
11122 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
11124 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
11125 code = swap_condition (code);
11128 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
11129 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
11130 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
11131 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
11132 than an scc insn even if we have it.
11134 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
11135 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
11137 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
11138 && integer_zerop (arg1)
11139 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
11141 gimple srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (arg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
11142 if (srcstmt
11143 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
11145 enum tree_code tcode = code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR;
11146 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
11147 tree temp = fold_build2_loc (loc, BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (arg1),
11148 gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt),
11149 gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
11150 temp = fold_single_bit_test (loc, tcode, temp, arg1, type);
11151 if (temp)
11152 return expand_expr (temp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11156 if (! get_subtarget (target)
11157 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
11158 subtarget = 0;
11160 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11162 if (target == 0)
11163 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
11165 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
11166 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
11167 operand_mode, unsignedp,
11168 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
11169 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
11173 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
11174 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
11175 # define HAVE_casesi 0
11176 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
11177 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
11178 #endif
11180 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
11181 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction).
11183 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to the default
11184 label. */
11186 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
11187 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, rtx fallback_label,
11188 int default_probability)
11190 struct expand_operand ops[5];
11191 machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
11192 rtx op1, op2, index;
11194 if (! HAVE_casesi)
11195 return 0;
11197 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
11198 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
11200 machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
11201 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
11203 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
11204 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
11205 index_expr, minval);
11206 minval = integer_zero_node;
11207 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
11208 if (default_label)
11209 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
11210 omode, 1, default_label,
11211 default_probability);
11212 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
11213 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
11215 else
11217 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
11219 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
11220 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
11223 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
11226 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
11228 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
11229 op2 = expand_normal (range);
11231 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
11232 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
11233 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
11234 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
11235 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
11236 ? default_label
11237 : fallback_label));
11238 expand_jump_insn (CODE_FOR_casesi, 5, ops);
11239 return 1;
11242 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
11243 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
11244 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
11245 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
11246 #endif
11248 /* Subroutine of the next function.
11250 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
11251 in the table already subtracted.
11252 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
11253 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
11254 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
11256 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
11257 index value is out of range.
11258 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to
11259 the default label. */
11261 static void
11262 do_tablejump (rtx index, machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
11263 rtx default_label, int default_probability)
11265 rtx temp, vector;
11267 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
11268 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
11270 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
11271 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
11272 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
11273 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
11274 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
11275 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
11276 the maximum value of the range. */
11278 if (default_label)
11279 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
11280 default_label, default_probability);
11283 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
11284 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
11285 if (mode != Pmode)
11286 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
11288 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
11289 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
11290 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
11291 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
11292 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
11293 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
11294 #endif
11296 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
11297 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
11298 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
11299 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
11300 index = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, Pmode, index,
11301 gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE),
11302 Pmode));
11303 index = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, Pmode, index,
11304 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
11306 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
11307 if (flag_pic)
11308 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
11309 else
11310 #endif
11311 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
11312 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
11313 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
11314 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
11316 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
11318 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
11319 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
11320 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
11321 emit_barrier ();
11325 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
11326 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, int default_probability)
11328 rtx index;
11330 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
11331 return 0;
11333 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
11334 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
11335 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
11336 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
11337 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
11339 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
11340 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
11341 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
11342 expand_normal (range),
11343 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
11344 table_label, default_label, default_probability);
11345 return 1;
11348 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
11349 static rtx
11350 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
11352 rtvec v;
11353 unsigned i;
11354 int units;
11355 tree elt;
11356 machine_mode inner, mode;
11358 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
11360 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
11361 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
11363 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
11364 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
11366 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
11368 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
11370 elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
11372 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
11373 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
11374 inner);
11375 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
11376 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
11377 inner);
11378 else
11379 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_wide_int_const (elt, inner);
11382 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
11385 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
11387 tree
11388 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
11390 const char *unwind_and_version;
11391 tree decl, type;
11392 char *name;
11394 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
11396 case UI_NONE:
11397 return NULL;
11398 case UI_SJLJ:
11399 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
11400 break;
11401 case UI_DWARF2:
11402 case UI_TARGET:
11403 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
11404 break;
11405 case UI_SEH:
11406 unwind_and_version = "_seh0";
11407 break;
11408 default:
11409 gcc_unreachable ();
11412 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
11414 type = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
11415 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
11416 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
11417 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
11418 get_identifier (name), type);
11419 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
11420 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
11421 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
11423 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
11424 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
11425 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
11427 return decl;
11430 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
11431 libfunc. */
11434 get_personality_function (tree decl)
11436 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
11437 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
11439 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
11440 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
11441 return NULL;
11443 if (!personality
11444 && pk == eh_personality_any)
11445 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
11447 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
11448 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
11450 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
11453 /* Returns a tree for the size of EXP in bytes. */
11455 static tree
11456 tree_expr_size (const_tree exp)
11458 if (DECL_P (exp)
11459 && DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp) != 0)
11460 return DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp);
11461 else
11462 return size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
11465 /* Return an rtx for the size in bytes of the value of EXP. */
11468 expr_size (tree exp)
11470 tree size;
11472 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
11473 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
11474 else
11476 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
11477 gcc_assert (size);
11478 gcc_assert (size == SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (size, exp));
11481 return expand_expr (size, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (sizetype), EXPAND_NORMAL);
11484 /* Return a wide integer for the size in bytes of the value of EXP, or -1
11485 if the size can vary or is larger than an integer. */
11487 static HOST_WIDE_INT
11488 int_expr_size (tree exp)
11490 tree size;
11492 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
11493 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
11494 else
11496 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
11497 gcc_assert (size);
11500 if (size == 0 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (size))
11501 return -1;
11503 return tree_to_shwi (size);
11506 #include "gt-expr.h"